LG 50PZ650 Owner’s Manual

Add to my manuals
190 Pages

advertisement

LG 50PZ650 Owner’s Manual | Manualzz
OWNER’S MANUAL
LED LCD TV / PLASMA TV
Please read this manual carefully before operating the
set and retain it for future reference.
www.lg.com
2
LICENSES
LICENSES
Supported licenses may differ by model. For more information about licenses, visit www.lg.com.
<Analogue TV>
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby” and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
<Digital TV>
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby” and the double-D
symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.
ENGLISH
ENG
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO: DivX® is a digital video format created by DivX, LLC, a
subsidiary of Rovi Corporation. This is an official DivX Certified® device that plays
DivX video. Visit divx.com for more information and software tools to convert your
files into DivX video.
ABOUT DIVX VIDEO-ON-DEMAND: This DivX Certified® device must be registered in order to play purchased DivX Video-on-Demand (VOD) movies. To obtain
your registration code, locate the DivX VOD section in your device setup menu. Go
to vod.divx.com for more information on how to complete your registration.
“DivX Certified® to play DivX® and DivX Plus® HD (H.264/MKV) video up to 1080p
HD including premium content.”
“DivX®, DivX Certified®, DivX Plus® HD and associated logos are trademarks of
Rovi Corporation or its subsidiaries and are used under license.”
“Covered by one or more of the following U.S. patents :
7,295,673; 7,460,668; 7,515,710; 7,519,274”
NOTE
Image shown may differ from you TV.
yy
Your TV's OSD(On Screen Display) may differ slightly from that shown in this manual.
yy
The available menus and options may differ from the input source or product model that you are
yy
using.
3
LICENSES
ENGLISH
ENG
4
TABLE OF CONTENTS
TABLE OF CONTENTS
2
LICENSES
6
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
6
11
12
20
20
20
24
26
27
28
29
Unpacking
Separate purchase
Parts and buttons
Lifting and moving the TV
Setting up the TV
- Attaching the stand
- Mounting on a table
- Mounting on a wall
- Wall mounting bracket installation
- Tidying cables
- Not using the Desk-Type Stand
47
49
52
53
55
55
56
56
57
58
58
59
60
60
61
61
62
ENGLISH
ENG
30 REMOTE CONTROL
65
33
34
34
66
67
70
71
73
75
75
76
76
77
77
78
79
79
34
35
Magic Motion Remote Control Functions
- Installing RF Dongle
- Registering Magic Motion Remote Control
- How to use Magic Motion Remote Control
- Precautions to Take when Using the
Magic Motion Remote Control
35 WATCHING TV
35
35
36
36
37
38
38
38
39
40
41
42
42
43
44
45
Connecting to an antenna
- Connecting an antenna
Turning the TV on for the first time
Watching TV
Accessing Home menu
Managing programmes
- Automatically setting up programme
- Manually setting up programme (In
digital mode)
- Manually setting up programme (In
analogue mode)
- Editing your programme list
- Using favourite programmes
Using additional options
- Adjusting aspect ratio
- Changing AV modes
- Using the input list
Using the quick menu
46 ENTERTAINMENT
46
46
Network Connection
- Connecting to a wired network
80
83
84
87
90
90
90
91
91
91
91
92
92
92
93
- Connecting to a wireless network
- When a security code is already set
- Network Status
Premium Account Function
LG Apps Function
- Registration LG Apps
- Sign in with LG Apps account
- Using LG Apps
- Using My Apps
Web Browser Function
- Using Web Browser
- Browsing Favourite Websites
- Browsing Websites by Directly Entering
Address
- Viewing Visited Website List
Smart Share Function
- Connecting USB storage devices
- Connecting DLNA DMP (Digital Living
Network Alliance, Digital Media Player)
- Connecting DLNA DMR (Digital Living
Network Alliance, Digital Media Render)
- Browsing files
- Viewing Videos
- DivX® VOD Guide
- Viewing Photos
- Listening to music
Media Link Function
- Media Link Connection
- Using Media Link
- Viewing Movies
- Using Music Section
- Using TV Programme Section
- Installing Plug-Ins
DVR Function
- Precautions when using the USB Device
- Timeshift (PAUSE & REPLAY OF LIVE
TV)
- RECORDING
- SCHEDULE
- RECORDED TV
EPG (Electronic ����������������������
Programme�������������
Guide) Func�����
tion (In digital mode)
- Switch on/off EPG
- Select a programme
- NOW/NEXT Guide Mode
- 8 Day Guide Mode
- Date Change Mode
- Extended Description Box
MHEG (Multimedia and Hypermedia Information coding Expert Group) (In digital
mode)
- Teletext Within Digital Service
- Teletext in Digital Service
- Switch on/off MHEG
TABLE OF CONTENTS
93
93
93
- Select a programme
- Programme Listing Mode
- NOW/NEXT Guide Mode
94 3D IMAGING (ONLY 3D MODELS)
94
95
96
96
97
3D Technology
When using 3D Glasses
3D Imaging viewing range
Viewing 3D Imaging
- Setting 3D Imaging
98 CUSTOMIZING TV SETTINGS
98
99
99
100
107
111
112
113
117
118
The SETUP Menu
Customizing Settings
- SETUP Settings
- PICTURE Settings
- AUDIO Settings
- TIME Settings
- LOCK Settings
- OPTION Settings
- NETWORK Settings
- SUPPORT Settings
120 Connection Overview
121 Connecting to a HD receiver, DVD, or
VCR player
121 - HDMI connection
122 - DVI to HDMI Connection
123 - Component Connection
124 - Composite Connection
125 Connecting to a PC
125 - HDMI Connection
126 - DVI to HDMI Connection
126 - RGB Connection
128 Connecting to an Audio System
128 - Digital Optical Audio Connection
129 Connecting to Headphone Connection
129 Connecting to a USB
130 Connecting the Wireless Media Box
130 SIMPLINK Connection
131 - Activating and Using the SIMPLINK
menus
132TELETEXT
132
132
132
132
132
132
133
Switch On/Off
Simple Text
- Page selection
Top Text
- Block / Group / Page Selection
- Direct Page Selection
Fastext
133 - Page selection
133 Special Teletext Function
134MAINTENANCE
134
135
135
135
135
136
Updating the TV firmware
Cleaning Your TV
- Screen and frame
- Cabinet and stand
- Power cord
Preventing “Image burn” or “Burn-in” on
your TV screen
137TROUBLESHOOTING
139SPECIFICATIONS
150IR CODES
151EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE
SETUP
151 RS-232C Setup
151 Type of connector;
D-Sub 9-Pin Male
152 RS-232C Configurations
153 Communication Parameters
153 Command reference list
154 Transmission / Receiving Protocol
159OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
160
164
170
176
179
181
181
183
183
185
185
186
186
187
188
189
189
- GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
- GNU Lesser General Public License
- Mozilla Public License 1.1 (MPL 1.1)
- Apache License Version 2.0
- MIT license
- Expat license
- The FreeType Project LICENSE
- JPEG license
- OpenSSL License
- zlib/libpng License
- Portmap license
- Pixman license
- X.net license
- BSD license
- RSA Data Security license
- JSON license
- MS92 license
ENGLISH
ENG
119MAKING CONNECTIONS
5
6
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Unpacking
Check your product box for the following items. If there are any missing accessories, contact the local
dealer where you purchased your product.
The illustrations in this manual may differ from the actual product and item.
ENGLISH
ENG
Remote control and batteries
(AAA)
Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials CD
Polishing cloth1
(Depending on model)
Cleansing Cloths (Mitt)2
(Depending on model)
Owner’s manual
1 Gently wipe the spots on the cabinet with the polishing cloth.
2 Wipe spots on the exterior only with the cleansing cloths.
Do not wipe roughly when removing stains. Excessive pressure
may cause scratches or discolouration.
For cleaning front frame, please slowly wipe in one direction
after spraying water 1-2 times on cleansing cloths. Please
remove excessive moisture after cleaning. Excessive moisture
may cause water stains on the frame.
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV37**
x8
M4 x 12
Screw for assembly
Screw for fixing
(Only 32/37LV37**)
Water
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
7
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV55**, 42/47/55LW57**, 42/47/55/65LW65**, 47/55LW77**, 47/55LW95**,
47/55LW98**
x8
x8
x9
ENERGY AV MODE INPUT
TV
Home
SAVING
OK
M4 x 16
(Only 47/55LW95**,
47/55LW98**)
M4 x 12
(Except for
47/55LW95**,
65LW65**,
47/55LW98**)
M4 x 16
(Only 65LW65**)
3
6
8
9
LIST
0
FLASHBK
MARK
FAV
VOL
3D
CH
P
A
G
E
MUTE
P
MENU INFO
MUTE
Q.MENU
ENTER
BACK
EXIT
FREEZE
RATIO
Magic Motion Remote
Control,
Strap, Batteries (AA)
(Only 47/55LW77**,
47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**)
FPR 3D Glasses1
(Only 42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55/65LW65**,
47/55LW98**)
3D Glasses (AG-S250)
(Only 47/55LW77**)
Cable holder
(Depending on model)
Only 42/47/55LW57** 2, 42/47/55/65LW65**
ENERGY AV MODE INPUT
TV
Home
SAVING
OK
1
2
4
5
7
8
9
0
FLASHBK
LIST
3
6
MARK
FAV
VOL
3D
CH
P
A
G
E
MUTE
P
MENU INFO
MUTE
Q.MENU
ENTER
BACK
EXIT
L/R SELECT
FREEZE
RATIO
Magic Motion Remote Control,
Strap, Batteries (AA)
RF Dongle
RF Donglea Cable
1 The number of 3D glasses may differ depending on the country.
2 Sold separately for Australia and New Zealand.
Velcro
ENGLISH
ENG
Screw for fixing
(Only 32/37LV55**)
2
5
7
L/R SELECT
Screw for assembly
Composite gender cable Component gender cable
1
4
8
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 47/55LZ96**
ENERGY AV MODE INPUT
x4
x6
x6
TV
Home
SAVING
OK
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
LIST
0
FLASHBK
MARK
FAV
VOL
3D
CH
P
A
G
E
MUTE
P
MENU INFO
MUTE
Q.MENU
ENTER
BACK
EXIT
L/R SELECT
M4 x 7
M3 x 6
M4 x 14
Bolts for stand and wall mounting bracket assembly
Composite gender cable Component gender cable
FREEZE
RATIO
Magic Motion Remote
Control,
Strap, Batteries (AA)
Cable holder
Stand Rear Cover
Display Link Cable Cover
ENGLISH
ENG
3D Glasses (AG-S250)
Stand Base
Stand Body
x2
x2
Display Link Cable
(stand type and wall
mounting type)
x2
Wall Anchor
Wall Mounting Bracket
(one for the set and one for
the wall)
x2
Screw
Wall Mounting Bracket
Pushpin
Set Protection Bracket
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
9
Only 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**
x4
x3
M4 x 26
M5 x 14.5
(Only 50PZ57**,
50PZ65**)
x4
x3
M4 x 28
M5 x 24
(Only 60PZ57**)
Screw for assembly
3D Glasses
(AG-S250)
Cable holder
Protection cover,
Protection Tape
Power Cord
Power Cord holder
Ferrite core
(Depending on model)
Cable holder
Power Cord holder
Protection cover,
Protection Tape
Ferrite core
(Depending on model)
Only 50/60PZ95**
x3
M4 x 26
M5 x 14.5
(Only 50PZ95**)
x4
M4 x 28
ENGLISH
ENG
x4
x4
M5 x 14.5
(Only 60PZ95**)
Screw for assembly
Power Cord
Wireless LAN for Broadband
/DLNA Adaptor
(AN-WF100)
ENERGY AV MODE INPUT
TV
Home
SAVING
OK
1
2
4
5
7
8
9
0
FLASHBK
LIST
3
6
MARK
FAV
VOL
3D
CH
P
A
G
E
MUTE
P
MENU INFO
MUTE
Q.MENU
ENTER
BACK
EXIT
L/R SELECT
FREEZE
RATIO
Magic Motion Remote
Control,
Strap, Batteries (AA)
3D Glasses
(AG-S250)
10
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
CAUTION
yy
Do not use any unapproved items to ensure the safety and product life span.
yy
Any damages or injuries by using unapproved items are not covered by the warranty.
NOTE
The items supplied with your product may vary depending on the model.
yy
Product specifications or contents of this manual may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade
yy
of product functions.
How to use the ferrite core (Only Plasma TV)
yy
1 Use the ferrite core to reduce the electromagnetic interference in the PC audio cable.
Wind the PC audio cable on the ferrite core thrice. Place the ferrite core close to the TV.
10 mm(+ / - 5 mm)
[to an External device]
[to the TV]
(Gray)
[Cross Section of
Ferrite Core]
[Figure 1]
2 Use the ferrite core to reduce the electromagnetic interference in the power cable.
Wind the power cable on the ferrite core once. Place the ferrite core close to the TV and a wall plug.
ENGLISH
ENG
[to the TV]
[to a wall plug]
(1)
(Black)
[Cross Section of
Ferrite Core]
(2)
[Figure 2]
3 Use the ferrite core to reduce the electromagnetic interference in the LAN cable. Wind the LAN cable once on the small ferrite core and thrice on the big ferrite core. Place the ferrite core close to the TV.
[to an External
device]
[to the TV]
A
A
(1)
B
A (Gray)
B(Gray)
(2)
[Figure 3]
-If there are two ferrite cores, follow as shown in Figures 3(1).
-If there are three ferrite cores, follow as shown in Figures 1 and 3(1).
- If there are four ferrite cores, follow as shown in Figures 2(1) and 3(2).
-If there are six ferrite cores, follow as shown in Figures 1, 2(2) and 3(2).
[Cross Section of
Ferrite Core]
yy
For an optimal connection, HDMI cables and USB devices should have bezels less than 10 mm thick
and 18 mm width. (Depending on model)
B
A
*A
*B
B
A
10 mm
18 mm
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
11
Separate purchase
Separate purchase items can be changed or modified for quality improvement without any notification.
Contact your dealer for buying these items.
These devices only work with compatible LG LED LCD TV or Plasma TV.
3D Glasses
(AG-S230, AG-S250, AG-S270)
(Only 47/55LW77**, 47/55LZ96**,
50/60PZ57**, 50/60PZ95**,
50PZ65**)
Wireless LAN for Broadband
/DLNA Adaptor
(AN-WF100)
(Except for 47/55LW95**,
47/55LW98**, 50/60PZ57**)
Magic Motion Remote Control
(AN-MR200)
FPR 3D Glasses1
(AG-F2**)
(Only 42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55/65LW65**,
47/55LW98**)
e
om
H
Wireless Media Box
(AN-WL100W)
(Except for 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,
50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**)
OK
ENGLISH
ENG
P
TE
MU
Video Call Camera2
(AN-VC300)
(Depending on model)
1 The model name or design may be changed depending on the upgrade of product functions,
manufacturer's circumstances or policies.
2 Video Call Camera can be used with some LG TVs.
Video Call Camera is not available in every country.
12
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Parts and buttons
Image shown may differ from your TV.
yy
NOTE
TV can be placed in standby mode in order to reduce the power consumption. And TV should be
yy
turned off if it will not be watched for some time, as this will reduce energy consumption.
The energy consumed during use can be significantly reduced if the level of brightness of the picture
yy
is reduced, and this will reduce the overall running cost.
CAUTION
yy
Do not step on the glass stand or subject it to any impact. It may break, causing possible injury from
fragments of glass, or the TV may fall.
yy
Do not drag the TV. The floor or the product may be damaged.
yy
In case of some model, the thin film on screen is a part of TV, so don't take it off.
ENGLISH
ENG
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
13
Only 42/47/55/65LW65**, 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**
Screen
Only 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**
P
HOME
OK
INPUT
H
Touch
buttons2
Only 42/47/55/65LW65**
H
P
HOME
OK
INPUT
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
Speakers
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Power indicator
IN 4
ENGLISH
ENG
VIDEO
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
PR
/DVI
AV IN 1
IN 2
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
WIRELESS
CONTROL
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
RGB IN (PC) AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL DIGITAL ANTENNA/
CABLE IN
AUDIO OUT
Touch button2
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
Rear Connection panel
(See p.119)
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
vP^
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
NOTE
yy
You can set the power indicator light to on or off by selecting OPTION in the Home menu - SETUP.
14
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV55**
Screen
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
Power indicator
Speakers
H
P
HOME
Touch buttons2
INPUT
IN 4
ENGLISH
ENG
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
OK
VIDEO
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
PR
/DVI
AV IN 1
IN 2
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
WIRELESS
CONTROL
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
RGB IN (PC)
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL DIGITAL ANTENNA/
CABLE IN
AUDIO OUT
Touch button2
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
Rear Connection
panel
(See p.119)
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
vP^
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
NOTE
yy
You can set the power indicator light to on or off by selecting OPTION in the Home menu - SETUP.
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 42/47/55LW57**, 47/55LW77**
15
Screen
Buttons
P
OK
H
HOME
INPUT
Speakers
IN 4
ENGLISH
ENG
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Remote control and intelligent1
sensors, Power indicator
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
IN 2
PR
AUDIO
R
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
VIDEO
/DVI
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
RGB IN (PC)
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL DIGITAL ANTENNA/
CABLE IN
AUDIO OUT
Button
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
Rear Connection panel
(See p.119)
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
P
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
NOTE
yy
You can set the power indicator light to on or off by selecting OPTION in the Home menu - SETUP.
16
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV37**
/DVI
USB Apps
USB IN
H/P
Screen
IN 2
/DVI
IN 3
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
/DVI
IN 1 (ARC)
Power indicator
Speakers
P
HOME
OK
Only 32/42/47LV370S
Except for 32/42/47LV370S
ENGLISH
ENG
LAN
Touch buttons2
INPUT
LAN
AUDIO IN(RGB/DVI)
AUDIO IN(RGB/DVI)
COMPONENT
IN
COMPONENT
IN
AUDIO OUT
RS-232C IN (CONTROL & SERVICE)
2
1
RGB IN (PC)
AUDIO OUT
RS-232C IN (CONTROL & SERVICE)
AV IN
R
ANTENNA / CABLE IN
OPTICAL DIGITAL
VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R
L
AUDIO
AV IN
R
VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R
L
AUDIO
1
RGB IN (PC)
VIDEO
VIDEO
2
OPTICAL DIGITAL
13/18V
700mA Max
LNB IN
Satellite
ANTENNA
/ CABLE IN
Rear Connection panel (See p.119)
Touch button2
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
vP^
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
NOTE
yy
You can set the power indicator light to on or off by selecting OPTION in the Home menu - SETUP.
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
17
Only 47/55LZ96**
Screen
Speakers
P
OK
HOME
INPUT
H
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
Power indicator and
Touch buttons2
USB Apps
HDD IN
USB IN
DISPLAY LINK
IN3
1(ARC)
/DVI IN
Y PB PR / AUDIO
VIDEO/AUDIO AV IN
ANTENNA/CABLE IN
Rear Connection panel
(See p.119)
Button
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
P
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
NOTE
yy
You can set the power indicator light to on or off by selecting OPTION in the Home menu - SETUP.
ENGLISH
ENG
AC IN
/DVI
18
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**
USB IN 1/HDD IN
USB IN 2/USB Apps
Screen
IN 3(ARC)
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
Power indicator
Speakers
INPUT
HOME
OK
PB
IN2
/DVI IN1
Touch button2
R
2
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
COMPONENT IN
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO L/MONO
PR
1
ENGLISH
ENG
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
Touch buttons2
AV IN 1
LAN
Rear Connection
panel
(See p.119)
P
VIDEO
VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R
AV IN 2
ANTENNA IN
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
P
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
19
Only 50/60PZ95**
USB IN 1/HDD IN
USB IN 2/USB Apps
Screen
IN 3(ARC)
IN 4
Remote control and
intelligent1 sensors
Power indicator
Speakers
LAN
OK
WIRELESS
CONTROL
P
AV IN 1
Y
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
Touch buttons2
PB
IN2
/DVI IN1
Touch button2
R
2
1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
COMPONENT IN
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO L/MONO
PR
ANTENNA IN
Description
/I
Turns the power on or off.
INPUT
Changes the input source.
HOME
Accesses the Home menu, or saves your input and exits the menus.
OK ꔉ
Selects the highlighted menu option or confirms an input.
Adjusts the volume level.
P
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
1 Intelligent sensor - Adjusts the image quality and brightness based on the surrounding environment.
2 All of the buttons are touch sensitive and can be operated through simple touch with your finger.
ENGLISH
ENG
Rear Connection
panel
(See p.119)
HOME
VIDEO
INPUT
VIDEO
VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R
AV IN 2
20
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Setting up the TV
Lifting and moving the TV
When moving or lifting the TV, read the following to
prevent the TV from being scratched or damaged
and for safe transportation regardless of its type
and size.
CAUTION
Avoid touching the screen at all times, as this
yy
may result in damage on the screen.
It is recommended to move the TV in the box
yy
or packing material that the TV originally came
in.
Before moving or lifting the TV, disconnect the
yy
power cord and all cables.
When holding the TV, the screen should face
yy
away from you to avoid damage.
Put your TV on a pedestal stand and mount the TV
on a table or wall.
Attaching the stand
If you are not mounting the TV to a wall, use the
following instructions to attach the stand.
CAUTION
yy
Tighten the screws firmly to prevent the TV
from tilting forward. Do not over tighten.
Only 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**
1 Lay the TV with the screen side down on a flat
surface.
CAUTION
Lay a foam mat or soft protective cloth on the
yy
surface to protect the screen from damage.
Make sure no objects press against the
screen.
2 Assemble the parts of the Stand Body with the
Stand Base of the TV.
ENGLISH
ENG
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M4 x 16
4
Hold the top and bottom of the TV frame firmly.
yy
Make sure not to hold the transparent part,
speaker, or speaker grill area.
When transporting a large TV, there should be
yy
at least 2 people.
When transporting the TV by hand, hold the
yy
TV as shown in the following illustration.
Stand Body
Stand Base
3 Assemble the parts of the Stand Rear Cover
with the TV.
Stand Rear
Cover
When transporting the TV, do not expose the
yy
TV to jolts or excessive vibration.
When transporting the TV, keep the TV
yy
upright, never turn the TV on its side or tilt
towards the left or right.
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
4 Secure the TV and the stand with the 4 screws.
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M4 x 16
4
21
3 Assemble the TV as shown.
4 Secure the TV and the stand with the 4 screws.
Model
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,
32/37/42/47/55LV55**, 42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55/65LW65**, 47/55LW77**
1 Lay the TV with the screen side down on a flat
Screw for
assembly
32/37/42/47/55LV37**, M4 x 12
Number of
screws
4
32/37/42/47/55LV55**,
42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55LW65**,
47/55LW77**
ENGLISH
ENG
surface.
CAUTION
Lay a foam mat or soft protective cloth on the
yy
surface to protect the screen from damage.
Make sure no objects press against the
screen.
2 Assemble the parts of the Stand Body with the
Stand Base of the TV.
Model
Screw for
assembly
32/37/42/47/55LV37**, M4 x 12
32/37/42/47/55LV55**,
42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55LW65**,
47/55LW77**
M4 x 16
65LW65**
Number of
screws
4
Model
65LW65**
4
Stand Body
Stand Base
Screw for
assembly
M4 x 16
Number of
screws
5
22
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
4 Use the Display Link Cable (for stand; the
Only 47/55LZ96**
1 Place the stand base facing down on a table
or flat surface. Assemble the Stand Body with
the Stand Base using the screws provided
with the TV set.
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M4 x 7
4
shorter one) to connect the Stand Base and
the display link input on the TV. After connection, fasten the screws with a driver to mount
the cable tightly.
Stand
Base
Stand Body
5 Place the Stand Rear Cover properly.
2 Carefully place the TV screen side down on a
ENGLISH
ENG
cushioned surface to protect the screen from
damage.
3 Mount the stand to the TV set fitting into
grooves in direction of the arrows as shown in
the figure. Have the TV set align with the holes
for inserting screws. Assemble the Stand Body
with the TV set using the screws provided with
the TV set.
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M4 x 14
4
6 Place the Display Link Cable Cover and connect it with the Stand Body using the screws
provided with the TV set.
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M3 x 6
4
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
23
Only 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**
Only 50/60PZ95**
1 Lay the TV with the screen side down on a flat
1 Lay the TV with the screen side down on a flat
surface.
CAUTION
CAUTION
Lay a foam mat or soft protective cloth
yy
on the surface to protect the screen from
damage. Make sure no objects press
against the screen.
2 Assemble the parts of the Stand Body with the
Stand Base of the TV.
Model
50PZ57**, 50PZ65**
60PZ57**
surface.
Lay a foam mat or soft protective cloth
yy
on the surface to protect the screen from
damage. Make sure no objects press
against the screen.
2 Assemble the parts of the Stand Body with the
Stand Base of the TV.
Model
Screw for
assembly
M5 x 14.5
M5 x 24
Number
of screws
3
3
50PZ95**
60PZ95**
Screw for
assembly
M5x14.5
Number of
screws
3
M5x14.5
4
Stand Body
Stand Body
Stand Base
or
Stand Body
3 Secure the TV and the stand with the 4 screws.
Model
50PZ57**, 50PZ65**
60PZ57**
Screw for
assembly
M4 x 26
M4 x 28
Number
of screws
4
4
Stand Base
3 Secure the TV and the stand with the 4 screws.
Model
50PZ95**
60PZ95**
Screw for
assembly
M4 x 26
M4 x 28
Number of
screws
4
4
ENGLISH
ENG
Stand Base
24
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Mounting on a table
Securing the TV to a table
1 Lift and tilt the TV into its upright position on a
table.
-Leave a 10 cm (minimum) space from the
wall for proper ventilation.
Except for 47/55LZ96**
(Only 32/37LV55**, 32/37LV37**)
Fix the TV to a table to prevent from tilting forward,
damage, and potential injury.
Mount the TV on a table, and then insert and
tighten the supplied screw on the rear of the stand.
10 cm
10 cm
10 cm
10 cm
Only 47/55LZ96**
WARNING
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
To prevent TV from falling over, the TV
should be securely attached to the floor/wall
per installation instructions. Tipping, shaking,
or rocking the TV may cause injury.
10 cm
10 cm
21 cm
10 cm
2 Connect the power cord to a wall outlet.
CAUTION
yy
Do not place the TV near or on sources of
heat, as this may result in fire or other damage.
NOTE
Except for 47/55LZ96**
yy
Swivel 20 degrees to the left or right and
adjust the angle of the TV to suit your
view.
20
20
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Securing the TV to a wall
(This feature is not available for all models.)
25
Using the Kensington security system
(This feature is not available for all models.)
The Kensington security system connector is located at the rear of the TV. For more information of
installation and using, refer to the manual provided
with the Kensington security system or visit http://
www.kensington.com.
Connect the Kensington security system cable
between the TV and a table.
1 Insert and tighten the eye-bolts, or TV brackets
and bolts on the back of the TV.
Match the location of the wall bracket and the
eye-bolts on the rear of the TV.
3 Connect the eye-bolts and wall brackets tightly
with a sturdy rope.
Make sure to keep the rope horizontal with the
flat surface.
CAUTION
yy
Make sure that children do not climb on or
hang on the TV.
NOTE
yy
Use a platform or cabinet that is strong and
large enough to support the TV securely.
ENGLISH
ENG
-If there are bolts inserted at the eye-bolts
position, remove the bolts first.
2 Mount the wall brackets with the bolts to the
wall.
26
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Mounting on a wall
Attach a wall mount bracket at the rear of the TV
carefully and install the wall mount bracket on a
solid wall perpendicular to the floor. When you
attach the TV to other building materials, please
contact qualified personnel.
LG recommends that wall mounting be performed
by a qualified professional installer.
Model
50PZ57**
50PZ65**
50PZ95**
VESA (A x B)
400 x 400
Standard screw
M6
Number of screws 4
Wall mount
PSW400B,
bracket
PSW400BG
60PZ57**
60PZ95**
600 x 400
M8
4
PSW600B,
PSW600BG,
10 cm
A
10 cm
B
10 cm
10 cm
CAUTION
ENGLISH
ENG
Make sure to use screws and wall mount bracket
that meet the VESA standard. Standard dimensions for the wall mount kits are described in the
following table.
Separate purchase(Wall Mounting Bracket)
Model
32LV37**,
32LV55**
VESA (A x B)
200 x 100
Standard screw
M4
Number of screws 4
Wall mount
LSW100B,
bracket
LSW100BG
Model
42/47/55LV37**,
42/47/55LV55**,
42/47/55LW65**,
42/47/55LW57**,
47/55LW77**,
47/55LW95**,
47/55LW98**,
47/55LZ96**
VESA (A x B)
400 x 400
Standard screw M6
Number of
4
screws
Wall mount
LSW400B,
bracket
LSW400BG
37LV55**,
37LV37**
200 x 200
M6
4
LSW200B,
LSW200BG
yy
Disconnect the power first, and then move or
install the TV. Otherwise electric shock may
occur.
yy
If you install the TV on a ceiling or slanted
wall, it may fall and result in severe injury.
Use an authorized LG wall mount bracket
and contact the local dealer or qualified
personnel.
yy
Do not over tighten the screws as this may
cause damage to the TV and void your warranty.
yy
Use the screws and wall mount bracket that
meet the VESA standard. Any damages or
injuries by misuse or using an improper accessory are not covered by the warranty.
65LW65**
NOTE
600 x 400
M8
4
LSW600B,
yy
Use the screws that are listed on the VESA
standard screw specifications.
yy
The wall mount kit includes an installation
manual and necessary parts.
yy
The length of screws may differ depending
on the wall mount. Make sure to use the
proper length.
yy
For more information, refer to the manual
supplied with the wall mount bracket.
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Wall mounting bracket installation
27
3-1Drill holes with depth of 80 mm - 100 mm at
the anchor location with a 8 mm drill bit.
Only 47/55LZ96**
1 Carefully place the TV screen side down on a
cushioned surface to protect the screen from
damage.
2 Fasten the screws to mount the Wall Mount-
ing Bracket for the set and the Set Protection
Brackets to the TV set.
Screw for assembly
Number of screws
M4 x 7
M4 x 14
2
2
3-2Clean the drilled holes.
3-3Insert the Wall Anchor provided in the hole.
you want using the Wall Anchors and Screws
as shown below. You can adjust the level of the
Wall Mounting Bracket with the level gauge
attached.
3-4Push the Wall Mounting Bracket to the wall
aligning with the hole. Make sure that the angle
adjusting knob is located on the upper side of
the Wall Mounting Bracket.
3-5Screw the Screw for the Wall Mounting
Wall Anchor
Screw
Bracket into the hole. At this time, fasten the
Screw applying a torque of at least 45 kgf•cm.
ENGLISH
ENG
3 Mount the Wall Mounting Bracket to the place
28
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Tidying cables
NOTE
yy
Check the material of the wall and thickness
of finishing material.
yy
You can use the anchors and screws provided with the TV set for the wall made with
concrete, lightweight concrete, soft fieldstone, hard fieldstone, brick or cellular block.
yy
Do not mount on the wall made with plaster
board or medium density fibreboard (MDF).
In this case, the anchor and screws must be
inserted in the concrete inside of finishing
material. If there is no concrete inside, you
must install a separate hanger first and fix
the anchors and screws.
yy
For other cases, make sure that each fixed
part can resist the pull-out load of 70 kgf
(686 N) and shear load of 100 kgf.
Only 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,32/37/42/47/55
LV55**, 42/47/55LW57**, 42/47/55/65LW65**,
47/55LW77**, 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**
1 Gather and bind the cables with the Cable
Holder on the TV back cover.
Cable Holder
4 Connect the Display Link Cable (for wall
ENGLISH
ENG
mounting bracket; the longer one) to the
display link input on the back of the TV. Then,
mount the TV set on the wall in direction of the
arrow as shown in the figure.
5 Secure the set with the Wall Mounting
Bracket Pushpins.
Only 47/55LZ96**
1 Secure the power cord with the Cable Holder
on the TV back cover. It will help prevent the
power cable from being removed by accident.
Cable Holder
2 After connecting the cables as necessary,
install Cable Holder as shown and bundle the
cables.
Wall Mounting
Bracket Pushpin
6 Place the Stand Base in a proper location and
connect it with the Display Link Cable.
Cable Holder
ASSEMBLING AND PREPARING
Only 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**, 50/60PZ95**
1 Install the Power Cord Holder and Power
Cord. It will help prevent the power cable from
being removed by accident.
29
Not using the Desk-Type Stand
Only 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**, 50/60PZ95**
When installing the wall mounting bracket,
yy
use the Protection cover. This will protect the
opening from accumulating dust and dirt.
1 Push the supplied protection cover into the
opening at the bottom of the TV until it locks in
place.
Power Cord Holder
2 Gather and bind the cables with the Cable
Holder. Install the LAN cable as shown to
reduce the electromagnetic wave.
2 Attach the protection tape as shown in the
Cable Holder
CAUTION
figure below to keep the protection cover
secure while moving the TV set.
yy
Do not move the TV by holding the Cable
Holder & Power Cord Holder, as the Cable
holders may break, and injuries and damage
to the TV may occur.
Protection tape
ENGLISH
ENG
Protection cover
30
REMOTE CONTROL
REMOTE CONTROL
The descriptions in this manual are based on the buttons on the remote control.
Please read this manual carefully and use the TV correctly.
To replace batteries, open the battery cover, replace batteries (1.5 V AAA) matching
and ends to the label inside the compartment, and close the battery cover. Be sure to
point the remote control toward the remote control sensor on the TV.
To remove the batteries, perform the installation actions in reverse.
CAUTION
Do not mix old and new batteries, as this may damage the remote control.
yy
In Analogue TV and in some countries, some remote control keys may not work.
yy
LZ9600/LW9500/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
호주/뉴질,ENERGY
아시아,
AV MODE 이스라엘/남아공/이란
INPUT
ENGLISH
ENG
TV/
RAD
2 ABC 3 DEF
LIGHT
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
ENERGY
AV MODE
INPUT
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
TV/
RAD
SAVING
0
LZ9600/LW9500/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
1 2 ABC 3 DEF
Q.VIEW
LIST
MARK
FAV
4 GHI 53DJKL 6 MNO
CHAR/NUM
P
7PQRSAV MODEMUTE
8 TUVINPUT 9 WXYZ
DELETE
0
2
3 DEF
4 GHI 5
6 MNO
ABC
CHAR/NUM
7
P
8
9
0
Q.MENU
P
A
G
E
LIGHT
BACK
Q.VIEW
LIST GUIDE EXIT
ENERGY
AV MODE
MARK INPUT
SAVING
1
FAV
OK
CHAR/NUM
3D
2
DELETE
ABC
MUTE
P
INFO
0OK
호주/뉴질, 아시아, 이스라엘/남아공/이란
Alphanumeric buttons
5OKJKLEnters
6 MNO letters and numbers.
LIST
8 TUV 9 WXYZ (See p.40)
LIGHT
Accesses the saved programme list.
GUIDE EXIT
0 Q.VIEW(Space) ENERGY AV MODE INPUT
MARK
FAV Opens an empty space on the screen keyboard.
SAVING
CHAR/NUM
RATIOQ.VIEW
P
DELETE
1 previously
2 ABC 3 DEFviewed programme.
Returns to the
MUTE
TV/
RAD
P
A
G
E
SMART TV
RATIO
Q.MENU
LIVE TV
INFO
Premium Home
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
LIST
4 GHI
P
A
G
E
REC
LIVE TV
TV/
RAD
Q.MENU
2 ABC 3 DEF
BACK
LIST
SMART GUIDE
TV
3DEXIT
OPTION
4BACK
GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
Premium Home
1
TV/
RAD
3 DEF
INPUT
SAVING
Premium Home
7PQRS
SMART TVTUV 3D OPTION
PQRS
WXYZ
Premium Home
MUTE
AV MODE
SMART TV
아시아, 이스라엘/남아공/이란
제외
FAV
3D
DELETE
OK
JKL
MUTE
DELETE
ENERGY
Q.VIEW
FREEZE
REC
Q.MENU
FAV
CHAR/NUM
INFO
3D
BACK GUIDE
DELETE
MUTE
P
EXIT
SMART TV
3D OPTION
Premium Home
Q.MENU
OK
LIVE TV
INFO
BACK GUIDE EXIT
FREEZE
Q.VIEW
FAV
P
A
G
E
CHAR/NUM
3D
BACK GUIDE EXIT
REC
RATIO
0
MARK
REC
RATIO
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
LIST
OK
MARK
LIVE TV
P
A
G
E
P
RATIO
TV/
3D OPTION
RAD
Q.VIEW
SAVING
Premium Home
MARK Q.MENU
1
FAV
CHAR/NUM
P
A
G
E
ENERGY
SMART TV
LIST
(POWER)
Turns the TV on or off.
LIGHT
ENERGY AV MODE
INPUT
Illuminates the remote control buttons.
ENERGY SAVING (See p.101)
SAVING
Adjusts the brightness of the screen to reduce energy consumption.
1 2 ABCAV3 DEF
MODE (See p.43)
4 GHI 5 JKLSelects
6 MNO an AV mode.
INPUT (See p.44)
7PQRS 8 TUVChanges
9 WXYZ
the input source; Turns the TV on.
TV/RAD
Q.VIEW
LIST
0
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
Selects Radio, TV and DTV programme.
MARK
TV/
RAD
SAVING
1
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
REC
LIVE TV
DELETE
P
MUTE
SMART TV
3D OPTION
Premium Home
Q.MENU
OK
INFO
BACK GUIDE EXIT
FREEZE
P
A
G
E
LZ9600/LW9500/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
ENERGY
W7700/LW6500/LW5700
AV MODE
ENERGY
1
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
INPUT
TV/
RAD
SAVING
0 Q.VIEW
2 ABC 3 DEF
LIST
1
6 MNO
4 GHI 5 3D
JKL 6 MNO
P
7PQRS 8
MUTE
TUV
9 WXYZ
P
A
G
E
0
3D OPTION
Q.VIEW
Q.MENU
Premium Home
MARK
FAV
CHAR/NUM
P
A
RATIO
P GE
OK
DELETE
MUTE
LZ9600/LW9500/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
D OPTION
SMART TV
Q.MENU
Premium
EXIT
BACK Home
GUIDE Q.MENU
ENERGY
AV MODE
INPUT
7700/LW6500/LW5700
TV/
2 ABC 3 DEF
1
REC
2 ABC
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
7PQRS 8 TUV 9Scrolls
WXYZ
through the saved programmes.
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
0
MARK
AV MODE
FAV
Q.VIEW
1
LIVE TV
LIST
P
3D
DELETE
2 ABC 3 DEF
CHAR/NUM
RATIO
DELETE
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
0OK
Premium Home
OK
Q.VIEW
MARK
FAV
P
A
G
E
CHAR/NUM
RATIO EXITP
BACK GUIDE
DELETE
SMART TV
MENU
Premium Home
XIT
BACK GUIDE
Q.MENU
REC
LIVE TV
OK
INFO
RATIO
BACK GUIDE EXIT
EC
ATIO
P
A
G
E
MUTE
OPTION
REC
LIVE TV
INFO
P
A
G
E
SMART TV
4 GHI 5 JKL Q.MENU
6 MNO
LIST
P
LIVE TV
INFO
Q.MENU
Premium
Accesses the Premium menus.
Home
Accesses the Home menus.
Q. MENU (See p.45)
Accesses the quick menus.
EXIT
3D OPTION(See p.97)
Used for viewing 3D video.
Navigation buttons (up/down/left/right)
Scrolls through menus or options.
REC
OK
Selects menus or options and confirms your input.
BACK
Returns to the previous level.
GUIDE
Shows programme guide.
SIMPLINK (See p.130)
Accesses the AV devices connected to the TV;
Opens the SIMPLINK menu.
EXIT
Clears all on-screen displays and return to TV viewing.
ENGLISH
ENG
9 WXYZ
PAGE
Q.VIEW
Moves to the previous or next screen.
MUTE
3D OPTION
Premium Home
0
P
FAV
TV/
RAD P
A
G
E
MUTE
SMART TV
INFO
MARK
INPUT REC
6 MNO
P
DELETE
Deletes letters and numbers.
3MUTE
DEF
REC
Mutes
all sounds.
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
RATIO
INFO
LIVE TVCHAR/NUM
INFO
Q.VIEW
INPUT
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
LIVE TV
SAVING
3 DEF
AV MODE
TV/
RAD
BACK GUIDE EXIT
ENERGY
RAD
RATIO
DELETE
SAVING
LIST
REC
P
A
G
E
RATIO
TV/
RAD
SAVING
1
CHAR/NUM
ENERGY
OK
EXIT
+Adjusts
the volume level.
P
MUTE MARK
Selects a menu or option.
SMART TV
FAV (See p.41)
Premium Home Q.MENU
Accesses your favourite programme list.
CHAR/NUM
OK Switches between Letter and Number input modes.
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
3D(See p.94)
Used for viewing 3D video.
(See p.42)
EXIT
BACK GUIDE RATIO
Resizes an image.
FAV
SMART TV
LIST
Q.VIEW
Q.VIEW
MARK
FAV
DELETE
0
LIST
MARK
CHAR/NUM
P
A
G
E
2 ABC 3 DEF
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
AV MODE
31
SAVING
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
3 DEF
P
REMOTE CONTROL
INPUT
TV/
RAD
2 ABC 3 DEF
ENERGY
TV/
RAD
9 WXYZ
AV MODE
TV/
RAD
SAVING
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
1
T
INPUT
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
0
LIST
Q.VIEW
FAV
ENERGY
32
AV MODE
INPUT
TV/
P
A
PRAD GE
3D
DELETE
MUTE
REMOTE
CONTROL
0
AV MODE
P
A
G
E
3D OPTION
TV/
OK
RAD
23DABC 3PDEF
CHAR/NUM
DELETE
8 TUV 9 WXYZ
7Premium Home
8 Q.MENU
9
ome
0
TELETEXT BUTTONS (See p.132)
RATIO
These
P buttons are used for teletext.
DELETE
MUTEFor further details, see the ‘Teletext’ section.
FAV
REC
LIST
0
AV MODE
INPUT
1
CHAR/NUM
Premium Home
2
SMART TV
ENGLISH
ENG
UIDE EXIT
0
LIVE TV
BACK GUIDE EXIT
INPUT
TV/
RAD
DELETE
INFO
RATIO
SMART TV
3D OPTION
0
Q.VIEW
P
A
G
E
MARK
RATIO
OK
FAV
CHAR/NUM REC
LIVE TV
3D
INFO
DELETE
P
MUTE
BACK GUIDE EXIT
SMART TV
3D OPTION
Premium Home
Q.MENU
FREEZE
OK
RATIO
BACK GUIDE EXIT
FREEZE
REC
LIVE TV
INFO
RATIO
2 ABC 3 DEF
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
0
Q.VIEW
FAV
7Premium
PQRS Home
8 TUV Q.MENU
9 WXYZ
REC
INPUT
MARK
OK
FAV
23DABC 3PDEF
1
LIST
Q.VIEW
MARK
MUTE
4BACK
GHI GUIDE
5 JKL EXIT
6 MNO
LIST
OK
LIGHT
CHAR/NUM REC
1
AV MODE
SAVING
P
A
G
E
7Premium
PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
Home Q.MENU
SAVING
ENERGY
TV/
RAD
MUTE
4BACK
GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
GUIDE EXIT
LIST
OK
3PDEF
DELETE
AV MODE
Q.MENU
Q.VIEW
TV/
ABC
RATIO
ENERGY
INFO
RAD
SAVING
MARK
LIGHT
SMART TV
LIVE TV
호주/뉴질, 아시아,OK
이스라엘/남아공/이란
FAV
Q.MENU
P
A
G
E
REC
SMART TV
3D OPTION
LIGHT
INFO
RATIO
PQRS
TUV
WXYZ
ENERGY
호주/뉴질, 아시아, 이스라엘/남아공/이란
MARK
CHAR/NUM
P
A
G
E
LIVE TV
3D OPTION
OK
BACK GUIDE EXIT
Q.VIEW
LIST
Q.VIEW
TV/
FAV
1
UTE
INFO
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
0
MARK
아시아,
이스라엘/남아공/이란
제외
SAVING
P
A
G
E
2 ABC 3 DEF
REC
LIVE TV
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
4 GHI MUTE
5 JKL 6 MNO
V
1
Q.MENU
4 GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
5 JKL 6 MNO
P
P
A
G
E
MUTEColour buttons
ENERGY AV MODE These
INPUT
access special functions in some menus.
SMART TV
DELETE
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
EXIT
BACKAV MODE
GUIDEINPUT
ENERGY
FAV
Q.VIEW
FAV
BACK CHAR/NUM
GUIDE EXIT
RATIO
P
Premium Home
SAVING
REC
Q.VIEW
0
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
MARK
TV/
RAD
RAD
Q.MENU
1LIVE TV INFO
2 ABC RATIO
3 DEF
LV5500/LV3700/LV370S
LIST
P
A
MUTE
LIST
INPUT
Premium Home
SAVING
ARK
TV/
PRAD GE
OK
Q.VIEW
SMART TV
LETE
SAVING
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
ENERGY
3D
DELETE
7PQRS 8 TUV 9 WXYZ
MUTE
AR/NUM
RATIO
Home Q.MENU
4Premium
GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
DELETE
2 ABC 3 DEF
INPUT
CHAR/NUM
Home Q.MENU
4Premium
GHI 5 JKL 6 MNO
FAV
BACK CHAR/NUM
GUIDE EXIT
3D
P
0
AV MODE
1SMART 2TV ABC 3 DEF
LZ9600/LW9500/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
MARK
TV/
RAD
ENERGY
FAV
1 SMART2TVABC 3D3OPTION
DEF
OK
INPUT
Q.VIEW
MARK
CHAR/NUM
SAVING
LIST
0/LW7700/LW6500/LW5700
FO
0
LIST
MARK
P
A
G
E
SUBTITLE
CHAR/NUM
REC
3D
P
Recalls
your preferred
subtitle
in digital mode.
DELETE
INFO
MUTE
FREEZE
SMART TV
3D OPTION
Freezes the current
frame
while using the TV, AV, Component, RGB-PC, or
HDMI input source.
Premium Home Q.MENU
Control buttons (
)
Controls the Premium
contents, DVR or Smart Share menus or the SIMOK
PLINK compatible devices (USB or SIMPLINK or DVR).
LIVE TV (See p.79)
Return to LIVE BACK
TV. GUIDE EXIT
REC
Use to adjust DVR menu.
INFO (See p.90)
FREEZE
Views the information of the current programme and screen.
REC
RATIO (See p.42)
RATIO
LIVE TV INFO
Resizes an image.
SIMPLINK (See p.130)
Accesses the AV devices connected to the TV;
Opens the SIMPLINK menu.
P
A
G
E
LIVE TV
REMOTE CONTROL
33
Magic Motion Remote Control Functions
This item is not included for all models.
Refer to the Magic Motion Remote Control manual for operating instructions.
Please read this manual carefully and use the TV correctly.
When the message "Magic motion remote control battery is low. Change the battery." is
displayed, replace the battery.
To replace batteries, open the battery cover, replace batteries (1.5 V AA) matching
and ends to the label inside the compartment, and close the battery cover. Be sure to
point the remote control toward the remote control sensor on the TV.
To remove the batteries, perform the installation actions in reverse.
CAUTION
y Do not mix old and new batteries, as this may damage the remote control.
y In Analogue TV and some countries, some remote control keys may not work.
(POWER)
Turns the TV on or off.
Home
Accesses the Home menus.
Home
OK
Selects menus or options and confirms your
input.
Press this button to display the pointer when
it disappears from the screen. You can
control the TV by selecting Quick Menu on
the screen.
- If you press the Navigation button while
moving the pointer on the screen, the
pointer disappears, and the Magic Motion
remote control works as a common remote
control.
To display the pointer again, shake the
Magic Motion remote control from side to
side within 2 minutes after it disappeared.
(If 2 minutes have passed, press the OK
button to display the pointer.)
Home menu
Programme List
Only 3D models
Quick Menu
Navigation buttons
(up/down/left/right)
Scrolls through menus or options.
OK
P
MUTE
+Adjusts the volume level.
P ꕌꕍ
Scrolls through the saved programmes.
MUTE
Mutes all sounds.
ENGLISH
ENG
Pointer (RF transmitter)
Blinks the light when operating.
34
REMOTE CONTROL
Installing RF Dongle
(Only 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,
32/37/42/47/55LV55**, 42/47/55LW57**,
42/47/55/65LW65**)
Image shown may differ from your TV.
Registering Magic Motion Remote Control
1 Locate the designated Velcro attachment
The Magic Motion Remote Control operates by
pairing with your TV.
Register the Magic Motion Remote Control to use.
location on the TV. Then tear off the protection
paper and attach the Velcro. (The attachment
location is different depending on the TV model
you own)
How to register the Magic Motion Remote
Control
Velcro
To register the remote control, press the OK button
on the remote control while aiming it at your TV.
or
*Attach the RF dongle aligning with the upper left
corner bracket.
2 Connect the RF Dongle Cable plug on the RF
Dongle to a USB jack on the TV.
USB Apps
USB IN 2
ENGLISH
ENG
RF Dongle
How to Re-register the Magic Motion Remote
Control after Registration Failure
Reset the remote control by pressing and holding
both the OK and MUTE buttons for 5 seconds.
(Once the reset is complete, the light on the
Pointer blinks.) Then repeat the above procedure
to register the remote control.
How to use Magic Motion Remote Control
HDD IN
USB IN 1
1 Press OK button if there is no pointer on your
3 Attach the RF Dongle to the velcro as shown
below and then turn on the TV.
TV screen. The pointer will then appear on the
screen.
If the pointer has not been used for a certain
period of time, it will disappear.
2 You can move the pointer by aiming the Pointer
Receiver of the remote control at your TV then
move it left, right, up or down.
If the pointer does not work properly after clicking the OK button, leave the remote control for
10 seconds then use it again.
*If the RF dongle for the wireless media box is attached,
attach the RF dongle for the Magic Motion remote
control on the upper right of the back of the TV.
*To avoid wireless interference, keep the distance
between the RF dongle for the Magic Motion remote
control and the Wi-Fi dongle at 20 cm.
20 cm
NOTE
yySeparate purchase : 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,
32/37/42/47/55LV55**
yy42/47/55LW57** : Sold separately only for
Australia and New Zealand.
WATCHING TV
Precautions to Take when Using
the Magic Motion Remote Control
WATCHING TV
Connecting to an antenna
Connect an antenna to watch TV while referring to
the following.
To prevent damage do not connect to the mains
outlet until all connections are made between the
devices.
Connecting an antenna
Connect the TV to a wall antenna socket with an
RF cable (75 Ω).
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Use the remote control within the maximum
communication distance (10 m). Using the
remote control beyond this distance, or with
an object obstructing it, may cause a communication failure.
yy
A communication failure may occur due to
nearby devices. Electrical devices such as
a microwave oven or wireless LAN product
may cause interference, as this will use the
same bandwidth (2.4 GHz) as the Magic Motion Remote Control.
yy
The Magic Motion Remote Control may be
damaged or may malfunction if it is dropped
or receives a heavy impact.
yy
When playing a game using the Magic
Motion Remote Control, hold it securely by
wrapping its strap around your wrist and
adjusting the length with the adjustable ring.
yy
Take care not to bump into nearby furniture
or other people when using the Magic Motion
Remote Control.
yy
Manufacturer and installer cannot provide
service related to human safety as the applicable wireless device has possibility of
electric wave interference.
yy
It is recommended that an Access Point
(AP) be located more than 1 m away from
the TV. If the AP is installed closer than 1
m, the magic motion remote control may
not perform as expected due to frequency
interference.
35
ANTENNA/
CABLE IN
Wall Antenna Socket
INPUT
MENU
ENTER
VOL
CH
NOTE
Use a signal splitter to use more than 2 TVs.
yy
If the image quality is poor, install a signal
yy
amplifier properly to improve the image
quality.
If the image quality is poor with an antenna
yy
connected, aim the antenna to the correct
direction.
An antenna cable and converter are not
yy
supplied.
36
WATCHING TV
Turning the TV on for the
first time
When you turn the TV on for the first time, the
Initial setting screen appears. Select a language
and customize the basic settings.
1 Connect the power cord to a power outlet.
2 In Standby mode, press
the TV on.
(POWER) to turn
The Initial setting screen appears if you turn
the TV on for the first time.
NOTE
You can also access Factory Reset by
yy
accessing OPTION in the Home menu SETUP.
NOTE
DTV mode control buttons may not
yy
function based on country broadcasting
circumstances.(Only DTV)
For those countries without confirmed DTV
yy
broadcasting standards, some DTV features
might not work, depending on the DTV
broadcasting environment.(Only DTV)
To display images in the best quality for your
yy
home environment, select Home Use.
Store Demo is suitable for the retail
yy
environment.
If you select Store Demo, the any
yy
customized settings will switch back to the
default settings of Store Demo in 5 minutes.
4 When the basic settings are complete,
press OK.
3 Follow the on-screen instructions to customize
your TV settings according to your preferences.
ENGLISH
ENG
Language

Mode Setting

Power Indicator

Country
Selects a language to display.
(Except for Australia, New
Zealand, Singapore, South
Africa),
NOTE
yy
If you do not complete the Initial setting, it
will appear whenever the TV turns on.
yy
Disconnect the power cord from the power
outlet when you do not use the TV for a long
period of time.
Selects Home Use for the
home environment.
Sets the power indicator.
(When you select Home Use
from the Mode Setting - only
LED LCD TV)
5 To turn the TV off, press
(POWER).
Selects a country to display.
(Only Australia, New Zealand)

Time Zone
Selects the time zone and daylight saving.(Only Australia)

Network Setting

Auto Tuning
Sets your network to enable
network-related feature on
the TV.(Only 47/55LW95**,
47/55LW98**)
Scans and saves available
programmes automatically.
Watching TV
1 In Standby mode, press
the TV on.
(POWER) to turn
2 Press INPUT and select Antenna.
3 To turn the TV off, press
(POWER).
The TV switches to Standby mode.
WATCHING TV
37
Accessing Home menu
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of the following menus and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option you want and press OK.
4 When you are finished, press EXIT.
1
2
3
4
Sat. Jan. 1, 2011 12:00
Premium
5
6
Sign In
Exit
LG Apps
HOT
NEW
UCC Service
7
Movie Online
Unit convertor
Puzzle
National-flag
Horoscope
Mah-Jong
Winesound
Weather Info
World Nature
8
5:05 ~ 5:55
INPUT
SETUP
GUIDE
Photo Album
Social Network Service
Search
LG Apps
Web Browser
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Media Link
Arrow
Sudoku
My Apps
Description
Current Date, Time
Channel programme info
Function card: You can enjoy various content files by selecting each card and you can edit
the premium card by selecting 5 items.
Function card position
Sign In
Exit
Current watching channel screen
8
Enter INPUT, SETUP, GUIDE or FAVOURITE menu. GUIDE menu may be changed to
FAVOURITE based on country broadcasting circumstance.
9
Launcher bar
ENGLISH
ENG
9
38
WATCHING TV
Managing programmes
Automatically setting up programme
Use this to automatically find and store all available programmes.
When you start auto programming, all previously
stored service information will be deleted.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Auto Tuning and press OK.
5 Select Start to start automatic tuning.
ENGLISH
ENG
The TV scans and saves available programmes automatically.
6 When you are finished, press EXIT.
Manually setting up programme
(In digital mode) (Only DTV)
Manual Tuning lets you manually add a programme to your programme list.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Manual Tuning and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to DTV.
6 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
desired channel number and press OK.
7 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
NOTE
yy
If the TV scans a blocked programme, you
will be prompted to enter your password to
keep the programme scanned.
NOTE
yy
If the TV scans a blocked programme, you
will be prompted to enter your password to
keep the programme scanned.
WATCHING TV
Manually setting up programme
(In analogue mode)
Manual Tuning lets you manually tune and arrange
the stations in whatever order you desire.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Manual Tuning and press OK.
Assigning a station name
You can assign a station name with five characters
to each programme number.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Manual Tuning and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
6 Press the Navigation buttons or Number but-
6 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
TV. (Only DTV)
tons to scroll to the desired programme Storage.
7 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
TV System. (Except for Australia)
V/UHF or Cable.
9 Press the Navigation buttons or Number buttons to scroll to the desired channel number.
10Press the Navigation buttons to scroll and start
searching.
11Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Store and press OK.
12When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
NOTE
yy
If the TV scans a blocked programme, you
will be prompted to enter your password to
keep the programme scanned.
yy
To store another programme, repeat steps 6
to 11.
TV. (Only DTV)
Name and press OK.
7 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to select
the position and make your choice of the second character, and so on. You can use an the
alphabet A to Z, the number 0 to 9, +/ -, and
blank and press OK.
8 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Close and press OK.
9 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Store and press OK
10When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
ENGLISH
ENG
8 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
39
40
WATCHING TV
Fine Tuning
Normally fine tuning is only necessary if reception
is poor.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Manual Tuning and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Editing your programme list
When a programme number is skipped, it means
that you will be unable to select it using P
button during TV viewing.
If you wish to select the skipped programme,
directly enter the programme number with the
NUMBER buttons or select it in the Programme
edit menu.
This function enables you to skip the stored programmes.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
TV. (Only DTV)
6 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
Fine.
7 Fine tune for the best picture and sound.
8 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
ENGLISH
ENG
Store and press OK
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Programme Edit and press OK.
5 Edit programmes using the following buttons.
9 When you are finished, press EXIT.
Button
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
OK
P
Red button
Description
Highlight the programme type.
Scrolls through programme types or
programmes.
Edits programmes.
Selects the highlighted
Watch
programme to view.
Registers or cancels the
Set as Facurrent programme in
vourite
favourite programme list.
Selects a programme
Skip
number to be skipped.
Adds or deletes a proAdd/Delete
gramme.
(Only Analogue
The deleted programme
mode)
displays in blue.
Move
(Only Analogue Moves a programme.
mode)
Programme
Number Edit Selects your desired
programme number.
(Only Digital
mode)
Blocks or unblocks a
Block
programme.
Moves to the previous or next page.
Selects your desired favourite programme group.
6 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
WATCHING TV
41
Selecting a programme on the programme list
Using favourite programmes
1 Press LIST to access the programme list.
Add the programmes that you watch frequently to
the favourite list.
Button
Description
Selects programme list or recent
programme list.
1 Select a programme to add to the favourite list.
2 Press FAV.
Scrolls through programme.
Selects the highlighted programme to
view.
OK
P
Red button
TV/RAD
FAV
Moves to the previous or next page.
Edits programme.
Selects a desired programme mode.
Moves to the favourite programme
list.
2 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
NOTE
Description
Selects a desired favourite programme group.
Moves to the previous or next page.
P
Red button
Moves to the Programme Edit.
Register or cancel the current proGreen button
gramme.
TV/RAD
Selects a desired programme mode.
Moves to the favourite programme
FAV
list.
3 When you are finished, press EXIT.
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
If you select the blocked programme, you will
be prompted to enter your password.
Button
42
WATCHING TV
Using additional options
- Just Scan: Displays video images in the original size without removing parts of the edge of
the image.
Adjusting aspect ratio
Resize an image to view at its optimal size by
pressing RATIO while you are watching TV.
Just Scan
NOTE
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
You can also change the image size by
pressing Q. MENU or accessing Aspect
Ratio in the PICTURE menus.
yy
You can adjust the enlarge proportion using
the Navigation buttons.
yy
You can only select 4:3, 16:9 (Wide), 14:9,
Cinema Zoom in Component mode.
yy
You can only select 4:3, Original, 16:9
(Wide), 14:9, Cinema Zoom in HDMI mode.
yy
You can only select 4:3, 16:9 (Wide) in RGBPC, HDMI-PC mode only.
yy
In DTV/HDMI/Component (over 720p) mode,
Just Scan is available.
yy
In DTV(over 576p) mode, Just Scan is available in Australia only.
NOTE
yy
If you select Just Scan, you may see image
noises at the edge or edges of the screen.
- Original: When your TV receives a wide
screen signal it will automatically change to the
picture format broadcasted.
Original
or
Original
- Full Wide(Only DTV): When TV receives the
wide screen signal,it will let you adjust the
picture horizontally or vertically, in a linear
proportion,to fill the entire screen fully.
- 16:9: Resizes images to fit the screen width.
4:3 and 14:9 video is supported in full screen
without any video distortion through DTV
input.
Full Wide
or
Full Wide
- 4:3: Resizes images to the previous standard
4:3.
WATCHING TV
- 14:9 : You can view a picture format of 14:9
or a general TV programme in the 14:9 mode.
The 14:9 screen is viewed in the same way as
in 4:3, but is moved to the up and down.
43
Changing AV modes
Each AV mode has the optimized image and sound
settings.
Press AV MODE repeatedly to select an
appropriate mode.
Description
Changes to the previously customized
settings.
Cinema or
Use the optimized image and sound
THX Cinema settings for the cinematic look.
Sport
Use the optimized image and sound
(Only Plasma setting for dynamic action sports.
TV)
Game
Use the optimized image and sound
settings for fast gaming.
When playing a video game using
PlayStation or Xbox, it is recommended
to use the Game mode.
When in Game mode, functions related
to picture quality will be optimized
for playing games.
Off
- Cinema Zoom: Choose Cinema Zoom when
you want to enlarge the picture in correct proportion.
To change the ratio of the cinema zoom,
yy
press
and its range is from 1 to 16.
To move the zoom focus up or down, press
yy
.
Mode
ENGLISH
ENG
NOTE
yy
If you enlarge or reduce an image, the image
may be distorted.
44
WATCHING TV
Using the input list
Selecting an input source
1 Press INPUT to access the input sources.
-The connected device displays on each input
source.
NOTE
yy
You can also access the input source list by
selecting INPUT in the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the input sources and press OK.
Image shown may differ from your TV.
yy
Input List
▼
ENGLISH
ENG
Antenna
USB 2
USB 1
Component1 Component2
RGB
Page 1/2
NETWORK
AV1
AV2
HDMI1
HDMI2
HDMI3
▼
SIMPLINK
Input source
Input Label
Exit
Description
Antenna
Watch TV over the air and digital cable
broadcast.
USB
Play media files from a thumb drive.
NETWORK
Play media files from your home network.
AV
Watch video from a VCR or other
external devices.
Component
Watch video form a DVD or other
external devices, or through a digital
set-top box.
RGB
Use the TV as a computer monitor.
HDMI
Watch video from a HTS or other high
definition devices.
The disconnected input sources will be grey.
-To add an input label, press the Green button.
You can easily identify a device connected to
each input source.
-If you connect a new external device to the
TV, a pop-up window appears. Select Yes on
the pop-up window to select an input source.
-To access the SIMPLINK, press the Red
button. If you select “SIMPLINK and On”, the
pop-up window for the HDMI input will not
display.
WATCHING TV
Adding an Input label
Add a label to an input source so that you can
easily identify a device connected to each input
source.
45
Using the quick menu
Customize frequently used menus.
1 Press Q. MENU to access the quick menus.
2 Press Navigation buttons to scroll through the
Image shown may differ from your TV.
yy
Input Label
▼
Page 1/2
AV1
◄
►
AV2
◄
►
Component1
◄
►
Component2
◄
►
RGB
◄
►
▼
Close
1 Press INPUT to access the input sources.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the input sources.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the input labels.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
Menu
Aspect Ratio
Picture Mode
Sound Mode
Sleep Timer
Description (Depending on model)
Changes the image size (16:9, Just
Scan, Original, Full Wide, 4:3, 14:9,
Cinema Zoom)
Changes the image mode (Intelligent
sensor, Vivid, Standard, APS, Cinema
or THX Cinema or THX Bright Room,
Sport, Game, Photo, Expert1, Expert2)
Changes the sound mode (Standard,
Music, Cinema, Sport, Game)
Sets the length of time until the TV to
turns off.
Recalls your preferred subtitle in
digital mode.
Changes the sound output.
Subtitle
Language
Audio or
Audio
Language
Energy Saving Reduces the power consumption
by adjusting the screen brightness.
(Intelligent Sensor, Auto, Off, Minimum, Medium, Maximum, Screen Off)
AV Mode
Sets the optimized image and sound
settings (Off, Cinema or THX Cinema,
Sport, Game)
Skip Off/On
Sets the Skip Off/On.
USB Device
Eject a USB device from the TV set.
The menu is displayed only when the
USB device is connected.
NOTE
The available menus and options may differ
yy
from the input source that you are using.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to the option
you want.
4 When you are finished, press Q. MENU.
ENGLISH
ENG
2 Press the Green button.
following menus and press OK.
46
ENTERTAINMENT
ENTERTAINMENT
CAUTION
yy
Do not connect a modular phone cable to the
LAN port.
yy
Since there are various connection methods, please follow the specifications of your
telecommunication carrier or internet service
provider.
yy
After connecting the LAN port, use the
Premium or LG Apps menu.
Network Connection
Connecting to a wired network
USB IN 1
HDD IN
USB IN 2
USB Apps
Connect the TV to a local area network (LAN) via
the LAN port as shown in the following illustration
and set up the network settings.
If wired and wireless networks are both available,
wired is the preferred method.
After making a physical connection, a small
number of home networks may require the TV
network settings to be adjusted. For most home
networks, the TV will connect to automatically
without any adjustments.
For detail information, contact your internet provider or router manual.
IN 4
/DVI
To set up the network settings: (Even if your TV
has already connected automatically, running
setup again will not harm anything),
WIRELESS
CONTROL
IN 3
/DVI
IN 2
VIDEO
PR
AUDIO
SETUP and press OK.
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
/DVI
PB
VIDEO
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
AV IN 1
IN 1
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to NETAV IN 2
LAN
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGITAL
DIGIT
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
WORK and press OK.
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
ENGLISH
ENG
4 Press the Navigation buttons to select Network Setting and press OK.
5 If wired and wireless are simultaneously conRouter
@
Internet
LAN
WAN
nected, press the Navigation buttons to select
Wired and press OK.
6 If you have already set the Network Setting,
select Resetting. The new connection settings
will reset the current network settings.
7 Select IP Auto Setting or IP Manual Setting.
ETHERNET
Cable modem
-If selecting IP Manual Setting, press the
Navigation and Number buttons. IP addresses will need to be input manually.
-IP Auto Setting: Select this if there is a
DHCP server(Router) on the local area
network (LAN) via wired connection, the TV
will automatically be allocated an IP address.
If you’re using a broadband router or broadband modem that has a DHCP (Dynamic
Host Configuration Protocol) server function.
The IP address will automatically be determined.
-IP Manual Setting: Select if there is no
DHCP server on the network or you want to
set the IP address manually.
8 When you are finished, press EXIT.
ENTERTAINMENT
47
Connecting to a wireless network
NOTE
yy
If you want to access the Internet directly on
your TV, the broadband internet connection
should always be on.
yy
If you cannot access the Internet, check
the network conditions from a PC on your
network.
yy
When you use Network Setting, check the
LAN cable or check if the DHCP in the router
is turned on.
yy
If you do not complete the network settings,
the network may not work properly.
(Except for 50/60PZ57**)
The LG Wireless LAN for Broadband/DLNA Adaptor, which is sold separately, allows the TV to connect to a wireless LAN network.
The network configuration and connection method
may vary depending on the equipment in use
and the network environment. Refer to the setup
instructions supplied with your access point or
wireless router for detailed connection steps and
network settings.
Setting up the AP (Access Point) or the wireless
router is required before connecting the TV to the
network. The easiest method is the WPS button
method (Third method in this section).
(Only 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98** : Built-in the
Wi-Fi Module, Unnecessary Wireless LAN for
Broadband/DLNA adaptor setup)
IN 4
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
ENGLISH
ENG
WAN
/DVI
IN 2
VIDEO
PR
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
/DVI
PB
VIDEO
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
LAN
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
Router
IN 3
WIRELESS
CONTROL
IN 1
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGITAL
DIGIT
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
@
Internet
ETHERNET
Cable modem
NOTE
yy
For enjoying pictures, music or video stored
on a PC using the router, a wired connection
is recommended.
yy
When the wireless port of the router is used,
there may be restrictions on some functions.
yy
It is recommended that an Access Point
(AP) be located more than 1 m away from
the TV. If the AP is installed closer than 1
m, the magic motion remote control may
not perform as expected due to frequency
interference.
48
ENTERTAINMENT
9 Press the Number buttons to Input the security
To set up the network settings,
key of AP and press OK.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to NETWORK and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to select Network Setting and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to select Wireless and press OK.
6 If you already set Network Setting, select Resetting and press OK.
The new connection settings resets the current
network settings.
7 Press the Navigation buttons to select Setting
ENGLISH
ENG
from the AP list and press OK.
-Scan the all available AP (Access Point) or
wireless routers within range and display
them as a list.
Selecting the wireless network setting type
Select the wireless network setting type.
Setting from the AP list
Simple setting (WPS-button mode)
Setting Ad-hoc network
ꔉ Next
ꕉ Previous
ꕯ Exit
8 Press the Navigation buttons to select an AP
(Access Point) or wireless router on the list. (If
your AP is secured, you will prompted for the
key.) And press OK.
Selecting AP
Select AP you want to connect.
Page 1/1
Input the new SSID
iptime
ASW
Access Point
Search
Network1
PIN
Previous
Connect
Exit
ENTERTAINMENT
When a security code is already
set
PIN (Personal Identification Number)
If your router is set to use a PIN, use the following
instructions.
1 Repeat step 1-7 on “Connecting to a wireless
network”.
2 Press the Red button to connect the access
point with PIN mode.
3 You can see the Network ID and Security Key
on your TV screen.
Enter the PIN number to your device.
PIN number is the unique 8 digit number of the
dongle.
49
WPS (Wi-Fi Protected Setup)
If your router or AP has a WPS button, it is the
easiest connection method. You simply press the
button on the router and then select the WPS on
the TV within 120 seconds.
1 Repeat step 1-7 on “Connecting to a wireless
network”.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to select the
Simple setting (WPS-button mode).
3 Press the WPS button on your router.
4 Go back to the TV and select Connect.
5 Repeat step 6-7 on “Connecting to a wired
network”.
4 Press OK to select Connect.
Connecting with PIN mode
PIN NUMBER : 12345670
Connect
For more information, check the AP manual.
ꔉ Next
ꕉ Previous
ꕯ Exit
5 Repeat step 6-7 on “Connecting to a wired
network”.
ENGLISH
ENG
Insert PIN number at the AP webpage and
press [Connect] button.
50
ENTERTAINMENT
Ad-hoc Mode
Ad-hoc mode allows the TV to use a wireless to
connect to a computer without using a router or access point.
1 Repeat step 1-5 on “Connecting to a wireless
network”.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to type in an IP
address and press OK.
Option
PC Setting
2 Press the Navigation buttons to select Setting
Ad-hoc network and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to select OK and
press OK.
4 Press OK to select Connect to connect Ad-hoc
network.
-You can see the Network ID and Security Key
on your TV screen.
-Enter this Network ID and Security Key to
your device.
-When needed, you can change the setting
information using the Red button.
ENGLISH
ENG
NOTE
When searching for wireless networks on
your PC using ad-hoc, the TV is named
LGTV10.
LGTV10 that appears in the list. (Select
yy
the same name as the network ID that
appears on your TV screen.)
TV Setting
Description
yyInternet Protocol(TCP/IP) of PC
needs to be set manually. IP address, Subnet Mask, and default
Gateway can be set with your own
discretion.
»»e.g.) IP address: 192.168.0.1 /
Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0 /
default Gateway: 192.168.0.10
yyVerify IP address and gateway of
PC. Input Gateway address of PC
to IP Address, and IP Address of
PC to Gateway, and select OK.
»»
e.g.) IP address: 192.168.0.10
/ Subnet Mask: 255.255.255.0 /
default Gateway: 192.168.0.1
6 Press the Navigation buttons to select Close
after Network setting is completed.
7 Press the OK.
ENTERTAINMENT
Tips for Network setting
yy
The use of a “Router” may not be allowed or its
usage may be limited depending on the policies
and restrictions of your ISP. For details, contact
your ISP directly.
yy
The wireless network operates at 2.4 GHz
radio frequencies that are also used by other
household devices such as cordless telephone,
Bluetooth® devices, microwave oven, and can
be affected by interference from them.It can
be interrupted by the device using 5 Ghz radio
frequencies. It is same device with LG wireless media box, cordless telephone, other Wi-Fi
device.
yy
It may decrease the service speed using Wireless network by surrounding wireless condition.
yy
Turn off all unused network equipment in your
local home network. Some devices may generate network traffic.
yy
In some instances, placing the access point or
wireless router higher up away from the floor
may improve the reception.
yy
The reception quality over wireless depends on
many factors such as type of the access point,
distance between the TV and access point, and
the location of the TV.
yy
To connect wireless AP, an AP that supports the
wireless connection is necessary, and the wireless connection function of the AP needs to be
activated. Please enquire to the AP supplier for
the possibility of AP wireless connections.
yy
Please verify the security settings of AP SSID for
wireless AP connection, and enquire to the AP
supplier for the AP SSID security settings.
yy
The TV can become slower or malfunction with
wrong settings of network equipments (wired/
wireless router, hub, etc). Please install correctly
by referring to the manual of the equipment, and
set the network.
yy
When AP is set to include 802.11 n, and if
Encryption is designated as WEP(64/128bit) or
WPA(TKIP/AES), the connection may not be
possible. There may be different connection
methods according to the AP manufacturers.
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Use a standard LAN cable with this TV. Cat5 or
better with a RJ45 connector.
yy
Many network connection problems during set
up can often be fixed by re-setting the router or
modem. After connecting the player to the home
network, quickly power off and/or disconnect the
power cable of the home network router or cable
modem. Then power on and/or connect the
power cable again.
yy
Depending on the internet service provider
(ISP), the number of devices that can receive
internet service may be limited by the applicable
terms of service. For details, contact your ISP.
yy
LG is not responsible for any malfunction of the
TV and/or the internet connection feature due
to communication errors/malfunctions associated with your broadband internet connection, or
other connected equipment.
yy
LG is not responsible for problems within your
internet connection.
yy
Some content available through the network
connection may not be compatible with the TV. If
you have questions about such content, please
contact the producer of the content.
yy
You may experience undesired results if the
network connection speed does not meet the
requirements of the content being accessed.
yy
Some internet connection operations may not
be possible due to certain restrictions set by the
Internet service provider (ISP) supplying your
broadband Internet connection.
yy
Any fees charged by an ISP including, without
limitation, connection charges are your responsibility.
yy
A 10 Base-T or 100 Base-TX LAN port is required when using a wired connection to this TV.
If your internet service does not allow for such a
connection, you will not be able to connect the
TV.
yy
A DSL modem is required to use DSL service
and a cable modem is required to use cable modem service. Depending on the access method
of and subscriber agreement with your ISP, you
may not be able to use the internet connection
feature contained in this TV or you may be limited to the number of devices you can connect at
the same time. (If your ISP limits sub-scription to
one device, this TV may not be allowed to connect when a PC is already connected.)
51
52
ENTERTAINMENT
Network Status
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to NETWORK and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to select Network Status.
5 Press OK to check the network status.
Option
Setting
Test
Close
Description
Return to the network setting menu
or wireless network setting type
menu.
Test the current network status after
setting the network.
Return to the previous menu.
ENGLISH
ENG
ENTERTAINMENT
Premium Account Function
LG’s Premium technology allows you to access a
variety of online services or contents directly on
your TV. Your TV offers instant streaming of movies, weather, videos, and photo album services
with a Premium account and an Internet connection.
Enjoy entertainment including not only entertainment content, but also up-to-the minute news,
weather updates, photo management, and more
by simply using the TV’s remote control without a
separate PC.
1 Press Premium to access the Premium option.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
content you want and press OK.
1
2
3
Return
Exit
UCC
Service
Movie
Online
Weather Info
Photo Album
Social
Network
Service
News
Sports
Service
Video
Streaming
Map
News
5
6
Search
Option
1
2
3
4
LG Apps Web Browser Media Link
Arrow
Sudoku
My Apps
Description
Moves to the weather setting screen.
Sign into the premium service.
Moves to the previous menu screen.
Returns to TV viewing.
Selects your desired online service.
5
6
yyIf a service requires you to log in, you
must first sign up for the service on your
computer and then log into the service
on the TV.
Launcher bar
3 Enjoy the premium features.
Notice
yy
These services are provided by separate
content provider.
yy
Please visit the content providers' web site
for specific information on their service.
yy
Premium menu can differ by country.
yy
Note that content may be updated automatically depending on the service provider, so
the content layout or operation method may
change without notice. Please refer to the
help menu on the screen.
yy
All information, data, documents, communications, downloads, files, text, images, photographs, graphics, videos, webcasts, publications, tools, resources, software, code,
programmes, applets, widgets, applications,
products and other content (“Content”)
and all services and offerings (“Services”)
provided or made available by or through
any third party (each a “Service Provider”) is
the sole responsibility of the Service Provider
from whom it originated.
yy
The availability of and access to Content
and Services furnished by the Service
Provider through the LGE Device are subject
to change at any time, without prior notice,
including, but not limited to the suspension,
removal or cessation of all or any part of the
Content or Services.
yy
Should you have any inquiry or problem
related to the Content or Services, you may
refer to the Service Provider’s website for
the most up-to-date information. LGE is
neither responsible nor liable for customer
service related to the Content and Services.
Any question or request for service relating
to the Content or Services should be made
directly to the respective Content and Service Providers.
yy
Please note that LGE is not responsible for
any Content or Services provided by the
Service Provider or any changes to, removal
of, or cessation of such Content or Services and does not warrant or guaranty the
availability of or access to such Content or
Services.
yy
Some content may be harmful to minors
depending on the service provider. Parental
guidance is necessary.
yy
The service may be interrupted if the Internet
connection is unstable. Please check the
connection status if you experience this
problem.
ENGLISH
ENG
Sign In
Sat. Jan. 1, 2011 12:00
4
53
54
ENTERTAINMENT
yy
The video list searched from the TV may be
different with the list searched from a web
browser on PC.
yy
The playback of videos may pause, stop, or
buffer depending on your broadband speed.
yy
For service that requires log in, join the applicable service on the website using a PC
and log in through the TV to enjoy various
additional functions.
yy
Only Plasma TV: If there is no user action
2 minutes following freezing image or video
on screen, the screensaver will activate
itself preventing a fixed image remaining on
screen.
Legal Notice
ENGLISH
ENG
IMPORTANT NOTICE RELATING TO NETWORK
SERVICE
All content and services accessible through this
device belong to third parties and are protected by
copyright, patent, trademark and/or other intellectual property laws. Such content and services are
provided solely for your personal noncommercial
use. You may not use any content or services in
a manner that has not been authorized by the
content owner or service provider. Without limiting
the foregoing, unless expressly authorized by the
applicable content owner or service provider, you
may not copy, upload, post, transmit, translate,
sell, modify, create derivative works, or distribute
in any manner or medium any content or services
displayed through this device.
YOU EXPRESSLY ACKNOWLEDGE AND AGREE
THAT THE DEVICE AND ALL THIRD PARTY
CONTENT AND SERVICES ARE PROVIDED "AS
IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED. LG ELECTRONICS EXPRESSLY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
AND CONDITIONS WITH RESPECT TO ANY
CONTENT AND SERVICES, EITHER EXPRESS
OR, IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
OF SATISFACTORY QUALITY, FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. LG DOES
NOT GUARANTEE THE ACCURACY, VALIDITY,
TIMELINESS, LEGALITY, OR COMPLETENESS
OF ANY CONTENT OR SERVICE MADE AVAILABLE THROUGH THIS DEVICE AND DOES NOT
WARRANT THAT THE DEVICE OR SERVICES
WILL MEET YOUR REQUIREMENTS, OR THAT
OPERATION OF THE DEVICE OR SERVICES
WILL BE UNINTERRUPTED OR ERROR-FREE.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES, INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE, SHALL LG BE LIABLE,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT OR TORT, FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, OR ANY OTHER
DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF, ANY INFORMATION CONTAINED IN, OR ANY CONTENT OR
SERVICE ACCESSED BY YOU OR ANY THIRD
PARTY, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGES.
Third party services may be changed, suspended,
removed, terminated or interrupted, or access may
be disabled at any time, without notice, and LG
makes no representation or warranty that any content or service will remain available for any period
of time. Content and services are transmitted by
third parties by means of networks and transmission facilities over which LG has no control. LG
may impose limits on the use of or access to certain services or content, in any case and without
notice or liability. LG expressly disclaims any responsibility or liability for any change, interruption,
disabling, removal of or suspension of any content
or service made available through this device.
LG is neither responsible nor liable for customer
service related to the content and services. Any
question or request for service relating to the
content or services should be made directly to the
respective content and service providers.
ENTERTAINMENT
LG Apps Function
Registration LG Apps
This feature is not available for all countries.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
Additional applications can be downloaded from
the LG App Store.
These functions may be not available for a certain
period of time depending on country or set. In such
cases, the buttons may be disabled.
They are enabled when the services are available.
New features may be added to this smart TV in the
future.
1
HOT
NEW
3
UCC Service
Movie Online
Unit convertor
Puzzle
National-flag
Horoscope
Mah-Jong
Winesound
Weather Info
World Nature
INPUT
Search
SETUP
LG Apps
GUIDE
Web Browser Media Link
3
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Sign In,
Sign Out
Exit
6
4
Social Network Service
7
Arrow
Sudoku
8
Press the Navigation buttons to select alphabet
and number and select OK.
4 The registration is completed.
NOTE
yy
If you wish to become a paid member or
change your information, please use your PC
and visit http://www.lgappstv.com
My Apps
9
Description
Sign in or sign out to the
premium service.
Returns to TV viewing.
Moves to LG Apps.
Moves to the LG Apps you
want directly.
These functions may be not
Search
available for a certain period of
Web Browser
time depending on country or
set. In such cases, the buttons
may be disabled.
Media Link
They are enabled when the
services are available.
Stores the most frequently
used apps among all downQuick Apps
loads. To change the list of
Quick Apps, see the "Using My
Apps".
Moves to My Apps.
You can browse all apps inMy Apps
stalled, change the list of Quick
Apps, and select and play the
app you want.
LG Apps
3 Create your ID and password.
ENGLISH
ENG
5
Photo Album
5:05 ~ 5:55
-You can only register as a free member from
your TV.
Exit
LG Apps
Premium
2 Press Red button to register.
2
Sign In
Sat. Jan. 1, 2011 12:00
55
56
ENTERTAINMENT
Sign in with LG Apps account
Using LG Apps
To enjoy LG Apps with your account, you need
sign in with the LG Apps account.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the LG
2 Press Red button to sign in.
It displays the keyboard menu for entering ID
and password.
-If you are not a member, press Red button
again. You can only register as a free member from your TV.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
2 Sign in on your TV.
Apps and press OK.
4 Edit the Apps by using following menu.
1
LG Apps
7
All
Game
Colouring
8
TOP
ENGLISH
ENG
1
2
3
4
5
1 After sign in, press Red button again.
A pop-up window will appears.
6
desired menu option and press OK.
Account Setting
Change User
Sign Out
7
Close
8
3 Manage the ID by using following menu.
Option
Account
Setting
Description
Check basic information, apps you
purchased and apps installed on
your TV.
Change User Changes your account.
Sign Out
Sign out the premium service.
Education
Wine Sound Unit Convertor
Exit
News/info.
TIE
Tarot
Sight Test
National Flag
Fitness
COLOUR
Calendar
Yoga
MahJong
Horoscope
GEMS Quest
First Aid
PAID
ID Management
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Life
5
Back
6
4 Enjoy LG Apps.
yy
You can download a paid app on up to five
TVs.
4
My Apps
NEW
- If you check "Auto Sign In", you are automatically logged in whenever you turn on TV.
NOTE
Entertainment
3
Search
HOT
alphabet or number and press OK.
You can enjoy Premium service, LG Apps, My
Apps and much more.
2
Sign In
Option
Sign In,
Sign Out
Search
Description
Sign in or out to use the LG
Apps.
Search the LG Apps.
My Apps
Moves to My Apps.
Back
Move to the previous screen.
Exit
Exit the LG Apps.
yyHOT: Most downloaded
apps in the past 7 days
yyNEW: Most recently released apps
yyTOP PAID: Most downloaded paid apps
Apps Sorting
yyTOP FREE: Most downloaded free apps
yyALL: Alphabetical order
yyMoves to the previous or
next page using P
button.
Shows the LG Apps category
Apps Category
(All, Game, Entertainment, Life,
Education, News/info.)
Live TV
Watches the current programme.
ENTERTAINMENT
Using My Apps
Purchasing and Installing Apps.
Log in first to purchase apps.
1 Enter the LG Apps after sign in.
1 Press the Navigation buttons to select Apps
you want and press OK.
You can see the information of the App.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the My
Apps and press OK.
2 Press Purchase to buy a App.
1
� lgtv2011
4
2
� My Apps
57
56
My Apps
3
7
Sign In
8
Edit
Exit
9
Back
Horoscope
Search
LG Apps
Web Browser
Horoscope
COLOUR
Yoga
Media Link
Arrow
Sudoku
Home
Game
5
6
7
8
Free
3
Horoscope is classical game.
Install
Rate this App
4
SUN
Final update date
2011/1/2
Version 1.0
3 Mbyte
0 Ratings
★★★★★
ꔍ
2
1
Page 1/1
Option
1
Description
Sign in or out to use the LG
Apps.
Move to My Apps.
Back
Move to the previous screen.
6
Install
7
Rate this App
Shows the description of the
current Apps.
Shows the fee of the current
app.
Install or purchase the App.
You can purchase an app on
either your PC or TV, but it
can be installed and played
only on the TV.
y If you want to purchase a
paid app, you need to sign
up as a paid member on
www.lgappstv.com.
y If you don't have enough
available space on your
TV, you can download
apps to the USB storage
device.
y You can play, delete or
move the apps stored on
the USB storage device
onto the My Apps screen.
Rate the app you purchased
with stars.
8
App info.
Shows the information of the
current Apps.
5
App description
Fee
NOTE
y To store apps in the USB storage device, make
sure that it is connected to the USB Apps port.
y Up to 1000 apps can be stored as USB apps.
y The USB storage device containing apps cannot be
used for storing other types of data.
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
-
Description
Shows the amount of used and available memories.
Current page number/total number of
pages of My Apps.
Shows the downloaded apps.
Moves to the previous or next page using
P
button.
Moves the LG Apps.
Quick Apps.
Sign In the LG Apps.
After sign in, manage the ID option (Account Setting, Change User, Sign Out).
Edit the My Apps.
Exit the My Apps.
Move to the Home menu.
Delete the Apps.
ENGLISH
ENG
1
2
3
4
Option
Sign In,
Sign Out
My Apps
Delete
58
ENTERTAINMENT
Web Browser Function
Using Web Browser
The Web Browser allows you to view Web pages
on your TV.
1 Connect to the network.
2 Press Home to access the Home menu.
More information about the Web Browser
ꔈThe web browser on this device supports Flash
8 and earlier.
ꔈThe web browser on this device does not support platform-dependent technologies such as
ActiveX.
ꔈThe web browser on this device only supports
preinstalled plug-ins.
ꔈThe web browser on this device may not support media formats other than the following
: JPEG / PNG / GIF / WMV (ASF) / WMA / MP3
/ MP4
ꔈSome Web pages may exceed the memory
allotment of the Web Browser. The Web Browser
will close when this happens.
ENGLISH
ENG
ꔈThe web browser on this device uses a single
built-in font. Some text may not be displayed as
intended.
ꔈThe web browser on this device does not support downloading of files or fonts.
ꔈThe web browser on this device is a TV browser. It may work differently to PC browsers.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Web Browser and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
URL and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
desired the URL address and press OK.
Browser Home
URL
Favorites
History
www.lg.com
OK
http://www.lg.com
ENG
Clear similar URL
Back
Exit
59
ENTERTAINMENT
Browsing Favourite Websites
6 You can browse websites on your TV.
1 Connect to the network.
Select the browser input window to display the
keyboard at the bottom of the screen.
2 Press Home to access the Home menu.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Web Browser and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Favorites and press OK.
Menu
By adding frequently visited websites to Favourites, you can browse them easily.
1
Exit
2
3
Browser Home
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
URL
Favorites
History
1/2 page
4
Button
1
2
3
5
6
7
Move to the previous page.
Move to the Favourites screen.
Zoom the screen in or out.
Add the current web page to Favourites.
Move to the search screen.
Move to the previous/next page in the
list of recently viewed web pages.
You can change the URL address to
move to other websites.
You can delete the list and cookies of
recently viewed web pages.
Exit the web browser.
Edit
5
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Back
6
Description
Exit
7
Browse a website by directly entering
the URL address.
Select a website in Favourites.
View the list of recently viewed web
pages.
Select a site to browse.
Edit Favourites.
-Move: Change the order in Favourites.
-Rename: Rename the sites added to
Favourites.
-Delete: Remove the sites from Favourites.
Move to the previous page.
Exit the web browser.
ENGLISH
ENG
4
Description
60
ENTERTAINMENT
Browsing Websites by Directly
Entering Address
Viewing Visited Website List
1 Connect to the network.
1 Connect to the network.
2 Press Home to access the Home menu.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
2 Press Home to access the Home menu.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Web Browser and press OK.
Web Browser and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
URL and press OK.
You can browse a website by directly entering
the URL address.
History and press OK.
You can view the addresses and visit times of
the websites you visited previously.
1
1
Browser Home
URL
2
Favorites
Browser Home
History
URL
www.lg.com
OK
History
1/2 page
http://www.wingspoon.com/seoul/index.nhn?
http://www.lg.com
http://me2day.net/
http://www.naver.com/
2
3
4
5
Favorites
<
http://www.facebook.com/
http://twitter.com/
http://www.paran.com/
;
:
9
ENG
Clear similar URL
Back
http://paran.com/
http://kr.yahoo.com/?p=us
http://www.nate.com
Exit
Clear History
ENGLISH
ENG
6
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
:
;
<
7
Description
8
Select other ways to move to the
website.
Enter the URL address. If the address
entered is similar to any of the sites
previously visited, a drop-down list will
be displayed.
Use the keyboard to enter the address. Select characters to enter.
Select the keyboard language.
Change the keyboard.
Clear the similar addresses appearing
below the address input field.
Move to the previous page.
Exit the web browser.
Hide the keyboard. Select the address
input field to display the keyboard
again.
Move the cursor left or right.
Delete the text before the cursor, one
character at a time.
Press this after entering the address
to go to the website.
3
Option
1
2
3
4
5
Back
4
Description
Exit
5
Select other ways to move to the
website.
Display a list of recently visited
pages. Select an item to move to
the page.
Clear the visited website list.
Move to the previous page.
Exit the web browser.
ENTERTAINMENT
Smart Share Function
Connecting USB storage devices
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Connect USB storage devices such as a USB
flash drive or external hard drive to the TV and use
multimedia features (See "Browsing files").
Connect a USB flash drive or USB memory card
reader to the TV as shown in the following illustration.
IN 4
/DVI
/DVI
IN 3
To disconnect a USB storage device, make sure to
end the connection properly to prevent damages
to the TV or files.
IN 2
1 Press Q.MENU to access the quick menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to USB
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
Device and press OK.
3 Disconnect the USB storage device only when
the message says that it is safe to remove.
AV IN 2
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
CAUTION
yy
Do not turn the TV off or remove a USB storage device while the USB storage device is
connected to the TV, as this could result in
loss of files or damage to the USB storage
device.
yy
Back up your files saved on a USB storage
device frequently, as you may lose or damage the files and this may be not covered by
the warranty.
Tips for using USB storage devices
yy
The TV recognizes only a USB storage
device.
yy
If you connect a USB storage device to the
TV through a USB hub, your TV may not
recognize the USB storage device.
yy
The TV may not recognize a USB storage
device that requires a special driver.
yy
The recognition speed of a USB storage
device may differ depending on the device.
yy
Only use a USB storage device which has
normal music or image files.
yy
Use only USB storage devices that are formatted as a FAT 32 or NTFS file system.
yy
You may need to connect a USB storage
device to an external power supply with a
power adapter.
yy
If the TV does not recognize a connected
USB storage device, replace the cable and
try again. Do not use an excessively long
cable.
yy
The TV does not support some USB storage
devices properly.
yy
You can use a multi-partition (up to 4) USB
storage device.
yy
You can use up to 4 USB storage devices at
a time by using a USB multi-card reader.
yy
The file alignment method of a USB storage
device is similar to the one of Window XP.
yy
You cannot create or delete a folder saved in
a USB storage device directly on the TV.
yy
The number of characters for a file name is
up to 100 English characters.
yy
Up to 1000 including folders and files can be
recognized.
yy
If there are too many folders and files in one
folder, it may not operate properly.
yy
The recommended capacity for a USB external hard disk is 1 TB or less and for a USB
storage device is 32 GB or less.
yy
If a USB external hard disk with the Energy
Saving feature does not work, turn the USB
external hard disk off and on again to make
it work properly. For more information, refer
to the user manual of the USB external hard
disk.
yy
USB storage devices below USB 2.0 are
supported as well. But they may not work
properly in the movie list.
yy
The electrostatic can cause USB device’s
malfunction. In this case, USB Device has to
be plugged again.
ENGLISH
ENG
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
or
61
62
ENTERTAINMENT
Connecting DLNA DMP (Digital
Living Network Alliance, Digital
Media Player)
ENGLISH
ENG
This TV can display and play many types of movie,
photo and music files from your DLNA server and
has been certified by DLNA for movies, photos and
music.
The Digital Living Network Alliance (DLNA) is a
cross-industry organization of consumer electronics, computing industry and mobile device companies. Digital Living provides consumers with easy
sharing of digital media through a wired or wireless
network in the home.
The DLNA certification logo makes it easy to find
products that comply with the DLNA Interoperability Guidelines. This unit complies with DLNA
Interoperability Guidelines v1.5. When a PC running DLNA server software or other DLNA compatible device is connected to this TV, some setting
changes of software or other devices may be
required. Please refer to the operating instructions
for the software or device for more information.
Please refer to "Smart Share Function" for additional information on supported file types and other
instructions.
NOTE
yy
The supplied Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials
CD-ROM is a customized software edition
only for sharing files and folders to this TV.
yy
The supplied Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials
software does not support following functions: Transcoding, Remote UI, TV control,
Internet services and Apple iTunes
yy
This manual explains operations with the
English version of Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials as examples. Follow the explanation
referring to the actual operations of your
language version.
yy
If there are too many folders and files in one
folder, it may not operate properly.
yy
For the DLNA option, use the Nero MediaHome programme that is provided with the
TV. However, we cannot guarantee that third
party programme will work perfectly.
yy
You can select a programme while viewing
the small preview programme list on your TV
screen.
yy
Check your network settings when the DLNA
option does not work properly.
yy
If there is an abnormal operation or an error occurs in Nero Media Home, the DLNA
option may not work properly. In this case,
exit Nero Media Home and restart the
programme. You can download the latest
version of Nero Media Home by clicking
the question mark at the bottom-left of the
programme.
yy
When the network is unstable, the device
may be slower or may need to load during
playback.
yy
When playing a video in DLNA mode, the
Multi Audio and Closed Caption features are
not supported.
yy
When selecting Full Screen in DLNA mode,
the ratio of the outputted screen may differ
from the original.
yy
When more than one TV is connected to
a single server in DLNA mode, a file may
not play properly, depending on the server
performance.
yy
If the server provides no information on a
specific file, it is displayed as "--".
ENTERTAINMENT
Installing Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials
Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials is an easy to use
DLNA server software for Windows.
Computer requirements for Nero MediaHome 4
Essentials
7 Click Typical and click Next. The installation
process is started.
8 If you want to take part in the anonymous collection of data, select the check box and click
the Next button.
9 Click the Exit button to complete the installation.
Sharing files and folders
After installing Nero MediaHome, you must add
folders you wish to share.
1 Double-click the Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials
icon on the desktop.
2 Click Network icon on the left and define your
network name in the Network name field. The
Network name you enter will be recognized by
your TV.
3 Click Shares icon on the left.
4 Click Local Folders tab on the Shared screen.
5 Click Add icon to open the Browse Folder window.
6 Select the folder containing the files you want
to share. The selected folder is added to the
list of shared folders.
7 Click Start Server icon to start the server.
1 Start up your computer.
2 Close all Microsoft Windows programmes and
exit any anti-virus software that may be running.
3 Insert the Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials CDROM into your computer’s CD-ROM drive.
4 Click Nero MediaHome 4 Essentials. The
installation wizard will appear.
5 Click the Next button to display the serial
number input screen. Click Next to go to the
next step.
6 If you accept all conditions, click I accept the
License Conditions check box and click Next.
Installation is not possible without this agreement.
NOTE
yy
If the shared folders or files are not displayed
on the TV, click the folder on the Local Folders tab and click Rescan Folder at the More
button.
yy
Visit http://www.nero.com for more information and software tools.
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Windows® XP (Service Pack 2 or higher),
Windows Vista® (no Service Pack required), Windows® XP Media Center Edition
2005 (Service Pack 2 or higher), Windows
Server® 2003 (Service Pack 1 or higher)
yy
Windows® 7 Home Premium, Professional,
Enterprise or Ultimate(32 and 64-bit)
yy
Windows Vista® 64-bit edition (application
runs in 32-bit mode)
yy
Windows® 7 64-bit edition (application runs
in 32-bit mode)
yy
Hard drive space: 200 MB hard drive space
for a typical installation of Nero MediaHome
stand-alone
yy
1.2 GHz Intel® Pentium® III or AMD Sempron™ 2200+ processors
yy
Memory: 256 MB RAM
yy
Graphics card with at least 32 MB video
memory, minimum resolution of 800 x 600
pixels, and 16-bit colour settings
yy
Windows® Internet Explorer® 6.0 or higher
yy
DirectX® 9.0c revision 30 (August 2006) or
higher
yy
Network environment: 100 Mb Ethernet,
WLAN (IEEE 802.11g), or faster
63
64
ENTERTAINMENT
Playing Shared Media
You can display and play movie, photo and music
content stored on your computer or other DLNA
media servers.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
Share and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
device you want and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to select DLNA.
Depending on the media server, this TV may
need to get the permission from the server.
Tips for using DLNA DMP
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
The DLNA function is not available in some
routers which do not support multicasting.
For more information, refer to your router
manual or contact the manufacturer.
yy
To play the file on the media server, the TV
and the media server must be connected to
the same access point.
yy
File requirements and playback functions on
the Smart Share may differ depending on the
media server used.
yy
There may be some restrictions by file
features and the media server that restrict
playback.
yy
Movie thumbnail is only supported when
DLNA server supports a Movie thumbnail.
yy
If there is an unplayable music file in the
Smart Share menu, the TV will skip the file
and play next file.
yy
Files in a folder can be played only when
they are of the same type.
yy
The file information indicated on the screen
may not always correct for music and movie
files in Smart Share menu.
yy
This TV only supports movie subtitle files
supplied by Nero MediaHome 4.
yy
The subtitle file name and movie file name
have to be the same and located in the same
folder.
yy
If subtitle files have been added after a directory has been indexed already, the user has
to remove and re-add the folder to the list of
shares.
yy
The DRM/*.tp/*.trp file in DLNA server is not
played while Movie List is in operation.
yy
MPO files are not played when Photo List is
in operation.
yy
The playback and operating quality of the
Smart Share function may be affected by
your home network condition.
yy
The files from removable media such as
USB drive, DVD-drive etc. on your media
server may not share properly.
yy
When playing the Media through DLNA connection, it does not support files protected by
DRM.
yy
Up to 1000 including folders and files can be
recognized.
yy
If there are too many folders and files in one
folder, it may not operate properly.
ENTERTAINMENT
Connecting DLNA DMR (Digital
Living Network Alliance, Digital
Media Render)
This supports remote playing of media files. Media
from a compatible device (Windows 7, Mobile
Phone with PlayTo, or other compatible DLNADMC device) can be "pushed" to the TV.
The DMR function only works properly when the
TV and PC are on the same local network.
1 To play a file, select the file by using the "Remote Play" feature in Windows 7.
To do this, right-click on the file you want to
play.
2 You can play a file only on a single TV set or
device even though multiple devices are connected. The playback speed depends on the
network status.
sun
Server Name
MYPC1
Picture display request from an external device.
NOTE
Subtitle is supported only on some DMC
yy
devices.
The DMR function may not work properly in
yy
a wireless network.
yy
The seek function of the DMC only works on
video files.
yy
The DMR is not available when another
function is operating (recording, playback or
Smart Share work etc.).
yy
Refer to the owner’s manual of the mobile
phone or other device to find out how to use
it to play a file.
yy
You can change the name of a connected
TV by double-clicking the item you want
to change in Control Panel > Network and
Internet > View network computers and
devices. (Only Windows 7)
yy
You cannot change the name of a TV while
DMR media is playing. Change it when playback is stopped.
ENGLISH
ENG
File Name
65
66
ENTERTAINMENT
Browsing files
Tips for using USB storage devices
Access the photo, music or movie lists and browse
files.
Video y MPG, MPEG, DAT, TS, TRP, TP, VOB,
Type
1 Connect a USB storage device.
Supported file format
y
2 Press Home to access the Home menus.
y
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
y
Share and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
y
device you want and press OK.
5 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to All Media,
Movie List, Photo List or Music List and
press OK.
Photo
- All Media: Shows all files in the file list.
- Movie List, Photo List or Music List:
Shows only one type of file in the file list.
MP4, MOV, MKV, DivX, AVI, ASF, WMV,
M4V
Max bitrate of playable movie file: 20 Mbps
(Mega bit per second)
Bit rate of audio format: within 32 kbps to
320 kbps (MP3)
Supported subtitle format(external) :
*.smi, *.srt, *.sub(MicroDVD, SubView
1.0/2.0), *.ass, *ssa, *.txt(TMPlayer),
*.psb(PowerDivX)
Supported subtitle format(internal) :
XSUB(Only, XSUB is the subtitle format used in DivX files), Text UTF- 8,
SRT,ASS,SSA(Only, this is the subtitle
format used in DivX-Plus HD files)
y Do not use the progressive option when
saving JPG files on your PC.
y It may take some time to open high-resolution images in full screen.
File
Item
Extensions
6 Press Navigation buttons to select a folder or
file you want.
2D
ENGLISH
ENG
2
1
Page 1/1
All Media
USB1 External
All Media Movie List
Photo List
Music List
Page Change
Page 1/2
jpeg
jpg
jpe
3
4
Drive 1
Supported
file
format
y SOF0: baseline
y SOF1: Extend
Sequential
y SOF2: Progressive
Photo
size
y Min: 64 x 64
y Max - Normal
Type: 15360
(W) x 8640 (H)
y Progressive
Type: 1920 (W)
x 1440 (H)
Supported
file
format
y mpo
Photo
size
y 4:3 size:
3,648 x 2,736
2,592 x 1,944
2,048 x 1,536
y 3:2 size:
3,648 x 2,432
5
Change device
Go to root folder
Exit
Go to upper folder
3D
(Only
3D
models)
6
Description
No.
1
Shows all media folders.
2
Current page number/total number of pages.
3
4
5
6
Moves to the previous or next page.
Current page number/total number of pages.
Files info or thumbnail.
Available buttons on the remote control.
Thumbnail information
Type
Video
Photo
Music
Abnormal files
Non-supported files
Music
mpo
Profile
y MP3
y Bit rate range 32 Kbps - 320 Kbps
y Sampling rate (Sampling Frequency)
MPEG1 layer 3: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz
MPEG2 layer 3: 16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz
* A copy-protected file will not play.
ENTERTAINMENT
Viewing Videos
67
7 Control playback by using the following
buttons.
Play video files on the TV. Your TV can display
video files from a USB storage device.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
Share and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
device you want and press OK.
01:02:30 / 02:30:25
Chapter
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Movie
Option
Hide
Exit
List and press OK.
5 Press Navigation buttons to select a folder or
file you want and press OK.
Button
6 Play a movie by using the following menus/buttons.
Page 1/1
Movie List
USB2 External
Page Change
Drive1
Stops the playback.
�
Plays a video.
�
Pauses or resumes the playback.
ꕚ
Scans backward in a file.
ꕙ
Scans forward in a file.
� and ꕙ
M1
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
M8
Red button
M9
M10
M11
M12
and < >
M13
M14
M15
M16
Change device
Go to root folder
Go to upper folder
Exit
Button
Navigation
button
OK
Description
Scrolls through the files.
P
Moves to the previous or next page.
Plays the highlighted file.
Change device: Changes to a different input.
Green button Go to root folder.
Yellow button Go to upper folder.
Red button
ENERGY
SAVING
3D (Only 3D
models)
Plays videos in slow motion.
Selects the frame directly.
The entire file is divided into 10 frames.
Frames may not be displayed depending
on the file.
Increases or decreases the brightness
of your screen.
Views the 3D imaging.
Q.MENU
Shows the Option menu (See p.69).
AV MODE
Select the desired source.
BACK
Hides the menu on screen.
To see the menu again, press OK button to display.
EXIT
Moves to the previous menu screen.
ENGLISH
ENG
Page 1/2
Description
�
68
ENTERTAINMENT
Tips for playing video files
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
The TV does not support the files encoded in
Motion JPEG. (See p.146)
yy
Some user-created subtitles may not work
properly.
yy
Subtitles may not display some special characters or HTML tags.
yy
Changing font and colour in subtitles is not
supported.
yy
Subtitles in non-supported languages are
unavailable.
yy
Video files with subtitle files of 1 MB or larger
may not be played properly.
yy
The screen may suffer from temporary interruptions such as image stoppage, faster
playback or no-sound for a while when you
change the audio language.
yy
If you play a damaged video file, the video
file may not be played correctly or some
player functions may not be unavailable.
yy
The TV may not properly play the video files
produced with certain encoders.
yy
If the recorded file does not have video or
audio, either video or audio is not outputted.
yy
If the TV plays the recorded file without video
or audio, either video or audio is not outputted.
yy
The TV may not smoothly play the video files
with a resolution higher than the supported
resolution for each frame.
yy
The TV may not properly play the video
files not included on the specified type and
format.
yy
The TV may not play the files encoded with
GMC (Global Motion Compensation) or
quarter-pel motion estimation.
yy
The TV supports the only 10,000 sync blocks
within the subtitle file.
yy
The TV supports the H.264/AVC codec up to
the profile level 4.1.
yy
The TV does not support DTS audio codec.
yy
The TV cannot play a video file whose size is
larger than 30 GB.
yy
If you play a video file through the USB connection that does not support the high speed,
the video player may not work properly.
yy
The video file and its subtitle should be in the
same folder and the name of the video file
and subtitle should be identical.
yy
The TV may not play the video files in the
supported file format depending on the encoded condition.
yy
Trick Mode does not support other functions than ꕙ if video files do not have index
information.
yy
Video file names that contain special characters may not be playable.
yy
For 3D WMV files encoded in dualstream,
3D mode is not supported. (Only 3D models)
yy
While changing the Audio language in dual
Audio Supported movie Files, there may
occur some delay in audio listening during
changeover.
ENTERTAINMENT
Q.MENU options for movie list
NOTE
1 Press Q. MENU.
A pop-up window will appears.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
option and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the following options and press OK.
Set Video Play.
Option
Description
Subtitle font selection. When set to
default, contents are displayed in the language set in "Option - Language - Menu
Language."
Code Page
Sync
Position
Size
Repeat
Description
Latin1
English, French, Spanish,
Portuguese, Malaysia,
Indonesia
Cyrillic
Russian
Thai
Thai
Hebrew
Hebrew
Arabic
Arab, Parsi, Krudish
Unicode
(UTF-16)
Vietnamese language
If the video is not synchronized
with the captions, it can be adjusted by
0.5 second.
Move the location of the subtitles.
Changes the subtitle font size.
Turn on/off repeat function of movie
playback. When turned on, the file within
the folder will be played back repeatedly.
When turned off, if the next file name
is similar to the previous file, it can be
played sequentially.
yy
Option values changed in Movie List does
not affect Photo List and Music List.
yy
Option value changed in Photo List and
Music List are changed likewise in Photo List
and Music List excluding Movie List.
yy
When replaying a video file after stopping,
select “Yes” to restart where it previously
stopped.
yy
If continuous series files exist within the folder, the next file will automatically be played.
But, this excludes cases when the Repeat
function of Movie List Option is turned “On”.
Set Video.
Allows you to change Video presets. (Refer to
“PICTURE Settings”)
Set Audio.
Allows you to change Audio presets. (Refer to
“AUDIO Settings”)
Set DivX PLUS HD
These options are enabled only when the movie
file being played contains the title, edition and
authored chapter information.
Option
Description
Title
For files with more than one title, select
the title you want to play.
Edition
For files with more than one edition,
select the edition you want to play.
yyAn edition refers to the playback
order set based on the chapters.
Authored
Chapter
Select and play the chapter you want.
ENGLISH
ENG
Selects your desired picture format for
videos.
yyFull Mode: Files are played in full
Picture
screen mode according to the aspect
Size
ratio of video.
yyOriginal Mode: Files are played in
their native size.
Changes the Language Group of the
Audio Lanaudio for video files. Files with a single
guage
audio track cannot be selected.
Subtitle
The subtitles can be turned on or off.
Language
Activated for SMI subtitles and can select
Language
the language within the subtitle.
Option
69
70
ENTERTAINMENT
DivX® VOD Guide
DivX® VOD Registration
In order to play purchased or rented DivX® VOD
contents, you should register your device with 10
digit DivX registration code from your device at
www.divx.com/vod.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to OPTION and press OK.
You should deregister your device with 8 digit DivX
deregistration code from your device at www.divx.
com/vod.
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to OPTION and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
Share Setting and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to DivX
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
Share Setting and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to DivX
VOD Registration and press OK.
6 View the registration code of your TV.
ENGLISH
ENG
i
DivX® VOD Deregistration
You must register your device to
play DivX protected videos.
Registration code : xxxxxxxxxx
Register at http://vod.divx.com
Deregistration and press OK.
6 Select Yes to confirm.
Deregistration code:
********
Deregister at http://vod.divx.com
Continue with registration?
i
Yes
No
7 When you are finished, press EXIT.
Close
7 When you are finished, press EXIT.
NOTE
yy
While you are checking the registration code,
some buttons may not work.
yy
If you use the DivX registration code of
another device, you cannot play the rented
or purchased DivX file. Make sure to use the
DivX registration code assigned to your TV.
yy
The video or audio files that are not converted by the standard DivX codec may be
corrupted or not be played.
yy
The DivX VOD code allows you to activate
up to 6 devices under one account.
NOTE
yy
Once the deregistration is executed, you
must register your device again to see DivX®
VOD contents.
ENTERTAINMENT
Viewing Photos
71
7 The following options are available while viewing photos.
You can view image files saved on a USB storage
device. The displays on the screen may based on
the from the model.
01_a.jpg
2008/12/10
1920 x 1080
479 KB
[1/66]
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
Share and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Slideshow
BGM
device you want and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Photo
List and press OK.
folder/file you want and press OK.
6 View photos by using the following menus/buttons.
Page 1/1
ꔵ Page Change
Drive1
Page 1/2
P1
P2
P3
P4
P5
P6
P7
P8
P9
P10
P11
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
� Change device
Button
Navigation
button
� Go to root folder
� Go to upper folder
Slideshow
BGM
Option
Hide
Exit
Description
Starts or stops a slideshow.
All photos saved in the current folder
Slideshow
display during a slideshow.
To set a slideshow speed, select Option.
BGM
Turns the background music on or off.
(Background To set the background music folder,
Music)
select Option.
Displays the current photo in Original,
(Colour Filter) Monotone, Sepia, Oil Painting and
(Only Plasma Vignetting.
TV)
Rotates photos clockwise (90°, 180°,
270°, 360°).
NOTE
Exit
(Rotate)
Description
Scrolls the file.
OK
Views the highlighted file.
P
Moves to the previous or next page.
Change device: Changes to a different input.
Green button Go to root folder.
Yellow button Go to upper folder.
Red button
Exit
y The supported photo size is limited. You cannot rotate a photo
if the resolution of the rotated
width is larger than the supported resolution size.
Views the photo in full mode or original
mode.
(ENERGY
SAVING)
3D (Only 3D
models)
Increases or decreases the brightness
of your screen.
Views the 3D images.
Option
Shows the Option menu (See p.72).
Hide
Hides the option window.
To display the options, press OK.
Exit
Moves to the previous menu screen.
ENGLISH
ENG
USB2 External
Hide
Option
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to a
Photo List
Option
or
72
ENTERTAINMENT
Q.MENU options for photo list
1 Press Q. MENU.
A pop-up window will appears.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
option and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the following options and press OK.
Set Photo View.
Option
Slide Speed
Description
Selects a slideshow speed (Fast,
Medium, Slow).
Selects a music folder for the background music.
Select Repeat or Random option.
BGM
NOTE
yyYou cannot change the
music folder while the background music is playing.
ENGLISH
ENG
NOTE
yy
Option values changed in Photo List do not
affect Movie List and Music List.
yy
Option values changed in Photo List or
Music List are changed likewise in Photo List
and Music List, but not Movie List.
yy
In some of the pictures zoom function may
not work depending upon the picture resolution and codec.
Set Video.
Allows you to change Video settings. (Refer to
“PICTURE Settings”)
Set Audio.
Allows you to change Audio settings. (Refer to
“AUDIO Settings”)
ENTERTAINMENT
Listening to music
73
7 Control playback by using the following buttons.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Smart
USB2 External
Share and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
device you want and press OK.
M1
M2
Page Change
M3
Page 1/2
001. - B01.mp3
002. - B02.mp3
003. - B03.mp3
004. - B04.mp3
00:00
00:00
00:00
00:00
005. - B05.mp3
006. - B06.mp3
007. - B07.mp3
008. - B08.mp3
00:00
00:00
00:00
00:00
009. - B09.mp3
010. - B10.mp3
011. - B011.mp3
012. - B012.mp3
00:00
00:00
00:00
00:00
013. - B13.mp3
014. - B014.mp3
015. - B15.mp3
016. - B016.mp3
00:00
00:00
00:00
00:00
001. - B01.mp3 �
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Music
00:03 / 02:58
Option
List and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to select a folder
Page 1/1
Music List
Button
or file you want and press OK.
Hide
Exit
Description
Stops playback.
Plays a music file.
6 Play music by using the following menus/but-
Pauses or resumes playback.
tons.
Skips to the previous file.
Skips to the next file.
Indicates a cursor.
Page 1/1
Music List
USB2 External
Page Change
Drive1
Page 1/2
M2
M3
M4
M5
M6
M7
M8
M9
M10
M11
M13
M14
M15
Change device
Button
Navigation
button
OK
Go to root folder
Go to upper folder
Q.MENU
Shows the Option menu (See p.74).
M12
BACK
Hides the option window.
To display the options, press OK.
M16
EXIT
Moves to the previous menu screen.
Exit
Description
Scrolls through the files.
Plays the highlighted file.
Moves to the previous or next page.
Change device: Changes to a different
Red button
input.
Green button Go to root folder.
Yellow button Go to upper folder.
Open music player.
Blue button
It is enabled during palying music.
P
Increases or decreases the brightness
of your screen.
Tips for playing music files
y This unit cannot support the ID3 Tag embedded
MP3 files.
ENGLISH
ENG
M1
(ENERGY
SAVING)
74
ENTERTAINMENT
Q.MENU options for music list
Set Audio Play.
1 Press Q. MENU.
Select Repeat or Random option.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Set Audio.
A pop-up window will appears.
option and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the following options and press OK.
NOTE
yy
Option values changed in Movie List does
not affect the Photo List and Music List.
yy
Option value changed in Photo List and
Music List are changed likewise in Photo List
and Music List.
Allows you to change Audio settings. (Refer to
“AUDIO Settings”).
NOTE
yy
The TV will not play copy protected files.
yy
If the TV is not in use for some time during
playback, the information box as a screensaver will appear to prevent image burn.
To return to the Music list screen, press OK.
File name
002. B02.mp3
00:31 / 04:04
ENGLISH
ENG
Time elapsed /Duration
ENTERTAINMENT
75
Media Link Function
Media Link Connection
The Media Link programme allows you to
connect to a Plex Media Server. The Plex Media
Server is free download from www.plexapp.com.
It will allow to play media files and download Plex
apps. The Plex apps download to your computer
and do not use any space on the TV.
1 Your TV must be connected to your home net-
NOTE
ꔈWe recommend that you install version
0.9.1.14 or later of PLEX Media Server on your
Mac or PC. (Download the installation file at
http://www.plexapp.com/medialink)
work. Either using a wired or wireless connection. (See p.46 to 52).
2 You can download PLEX at http://www.plexapp.com/medialink.
- For more information on how to install it,
please visit the website above.
3 When you run PLEX for the first time, the wiz-
ard guides you through the steps to set up the
programme.
- For information on how to use the wizard,
please visit the website above.
ꔈGUI is displayed in English and the data transmitted will not be displayed when using the following languages: Thai, Arabic, Persian,
Hebrew, Kurdish.
ꔈWhen playing the files stored on the computer
(movies, TV shows, music), the formats supported are the same as those for the DLNA
function. The skip to content function is not
supported when playing music. (Same for
DLNA)
ꔈYou may experience problems when playing
HD movies over Wi-Fi due to the network slowing down.
ꔈWhen using a router, the TV may not detect
the computer due to the router settings. (For
example, when using the multicast forward
function in some routers, TVs cannot detect
computers via Wi-Fi.)
ꔈSome plug-ins may not work, depending on
the media format.
ꔈPlug-ins are subject to change and may stop
working without prior notice, at the providers’
discretion.
ENGLISH
ENG
ꔈWhen using the video plug-in, initial buffering
may take a while if the TV does not support a
file to be played and conversion needs to be
performed on the computer. The conversion
performance may vary depending on the computer's performance and the network speed.
76
ENTERTAINMENT
Using Media Link
Viewing Movies
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
Media Link will retrieve information on shared
movies as described below.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Media Link and press OK.
3 The Media Link sections of the connected computer are displayed. Select an icon to view the
shared media in that category.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Media
Link and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Media Link
Video and press OK.
M's PC
1
Media Link
2
Movies
M's PC
Music
M's PC
TV show
M's PC
Video
Plug-i...
Music
Plug-i...
M's PC
Picture
Plug-i...
Movies
1
Sort by server
3
Device Selection
4
PLEX Online
5
Back
6
Exit
7
2
Search
ENGLISH
ENG
3
Option
Description
1
This is a list of categories you set on the connected computer.
2
3
4
5
6
7
This is a list of plug-ins for online content.
Change the section sorting.
- By server name: Sort the list by server
name.
- By item name: Sort the list by item name.
Select another device.
Using PLEX Online, you can install, remove
or update applications on the computer.
Move to the previous page.
Exit Media Link.
Filter
4
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Back
5
6
Exit
7
Description
Show information for the selected movie.
Show images captured from the movie file.
Search movies within the section.
Display the list according to the selected filter.
Select to play the movie in full screen mode. If
the movie has already been played, you can
continue from the last scene.
Move to the previous page.
Exit Media Link.
ENTERTAINMENT
77
Using Music Section
Using TV Programme Section
You can view information for the music files set for
the Music section and enjoy them.
You can view information for the programmes contained in the TV Show section and enjoy them.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Media Link and press OK.
Media Link and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the TV
Music section and press OK.
Show section and press OK.
Media Link
M's PC
Music
M's PC
1
2
TV Show > TV Sitcom > Season 2
1
3
3
2
4
Option
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Filter
5
Back
6
Exit
Search
4
7
Filter
5
Back
6
Exit
7
Description
Sort the music files in the selected section in
Option
Description
Sort the TV programme files in the selected
the order of artist > album > song title.
Select a folder or a song.
Show the artist, album and information for the
1
section in the order of programme name >
selected music.
Search music files within the section.
Display the list according to the selected filter.
Move to the previous page.
Exit Media Link.
2
3
4
5
6
7
season > episode.
Select a folder or a programme.
Show information for the selected programme.
Search TV programmes within the section.
Display the list according to the selected filter.
Move to the previous page.
Exit Media Link.
ENGLISH
ENG
Search
78
ENTERTAINMENT
Installing Plug-Ins
Media Link allows you to install plug-ins to enjoy
media content on the web.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
Media Link and press OK.
3 Press yellow button to select to PLEX online.
M's PC
Movie Plug-ins
1
2
Back
ENGLISH
ENG
3
Option
Exit
4
Description
Move the cursor to a plug-in to view the plugin information on the right pane.
Plug-ins already installed: You can run, update, reinstall or remove them.
1
Plug-ins not yet installed: You can install
them.
Once installed, you can run the plug-in by
selecting Video, Music or Picture Plug-in from
2
3
4
the Media Link main screen.
A list of plug-ins available for installation.
Move to the previous page.
Exit Media Link.
DVR Function
DVR Function
(This feature is not available for all model.)
Precautions when using the
USB Device
NOTE
Playing a movie via a USB connection that
yy
doesn’t support high speed may not work
properly.
USB storage devices below USB 2.0 are
yy
supported as well. But they may not work
properly in the movie list.
Please maintain the stability of external HDD
yy
by using the HDD benchmarking tool in order
to guarantee smooth action of HDD.
The HDD benchmarking tools is checking the
yy
performance of HDD that is read/write rate,
access time, stability. It will be able to search
at website and use easily it after download
the HDD benchmarking tool.
DVR USB hard disk supports only SSD
yy
or HDD disk types. (USB memory is not
supported.)
A SSD (Solid State Drive) has a limited
yy
number of write/delete cycles. A HDD (Hard
Disk Drive) is recommended for this product.
ENGLISH
ENG
Only a USB storage device is recognizable.
yy
If the USB storage device is connected
yy
through a USB hub, the device is not
recognizable.
A USB storage device using an automatic
yy
recognition programme may not be
recognized.
A USB storage device which uses its own
yy
driver may not be recognized.
In case of several partitions or a card reader,
yy
up to four memory cards are concurrently
recognizable.
The recognition speed of a USB storage
yy
device may depend on each device.
Please do not turn off the TV or unplug
yy
the USB device when the connected USB
storage device is working. When such device
is suddenly separated or unplugged, the
stored files or the USB storage device may
be damaged.
Please connect power to a USB storage
yy
device which requires an external power
supply. If not, the device may not be
recognized.
Please connect a USB storage device with
yy
cable is offered by USB maker. If connected
with cable is not offered by USB maker or an
excessively long cable, the device may not
be recognized.
Some USB storage devices may not be
yy
supported or operate properly.
The TV will display up to 128 characters of a
yy
files name.
Please backup important files because data
yy
on USB device may be damaged. Data
management is consumer’s responsibility
and as a result, the manufacturer does not
cover data damage.
The recommended capacity is 40 GB or over
yy
and 1TB or less for a USB HDD.
Any device with more than the recommended
yy
capacity may not work properly.
79
80
DVR Function
Timeshift (PAUSE & REPLAY OF
LIVE TV)
USB device Initialization
!
This function allows the unit to automatically
record live TV and make it available for viewing at
any time.
With the Timeshift turned on, you may pause and
rewind normal TV viewing at any time without
missing any of the live broadcast.
Timeshift and Recording functions may not work if
the signal strength is weak.
This function is only operated after initializating
USB Device.
To use LG DVR feature, USB storage
device needs to be formatted.
Do you want to continue?
OK
!
Cancel
Initializing will delete all existing data
in the USB device. Once initialized to
DVR format, the USB device cannot
be used with PC. To continue to initialize, select OK.
OK
Cancel
Connecting USB storage devices
/DVI
IN 3
/DVI
IN 4
ENGLISH
ENG
IN 2
1 Connect the USB device to the HDD IN jacks
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
on the side of TV.
2 To use the USB device (over 40 GB) for DVR,
AV IN 2
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
Initialization completed. Ready to
record.
Timeshift Mode
◄
On ►
Close
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
i
AUDIO / VIDEO
press REC to initialize the USB device.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to OK
and press OK.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to On or Off
and press OK.
execute USB Device Initialization.
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
1 Connect an unformatted USB for DVR and
H/P
NOTE
NOTE
yyIt initializes the HDD connected to the USB
as disk mode for DVR.
yy
It is activated only when the USB HDD available for DVR is connected.
yy
When USB Device Initialization is executed,
all the data stored in the USB device is
deleted.
yy
While performing USB Device Initialization,
do not remove the USB device. It may cause
error on the TV and the storage device.
yy
When initialization is completed, a popup
notice of completion is displayed and the
connected USB HDD is available for DVR.
yy
Depending on the capacity of the USB device, the initialization time may vary.
yy
The initialized USB device is not recognized
by the PC.
yy
When a USB device of less than 40 GB is
connected, the USB Device Initialization is
not activated.
yy
Supported maximum external HDD size for
back-up is up to 1TB.
DVR Function
Timeshift Mode change during using DVR
Timeshift Mode
Record/Schedule
◄
On
Schedule list Initialization
USB Device Reinitialization during using DVR
► Free Space 100GB
79h 03m
31h 37m
Apr.2 2010 15:30
You can see the recorded TV.
USB device Initialization
Recorded List
Schedule List
Close
� Recording starts.
Select schedule
by date
Select schedule
by program
Option
Recording starts
81
Exit
* Select schedule by program is not available in
New Zealand.
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button to show the DVR option
menu and press Q.MENU.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to USB
device Initialization and press OK.
4 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button to show the DVR option
menu and press Q.MENU.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
4 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to On or Off
and press OK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
Menu
Recorded List
Schedule List
Select schedule by
date
Select schedule by
program
Description
Moves to the Recorded List.
Moves to the Schedule List.
Moves to the Manual Timer.
Set up timer recording by going
to the Programme Guide.
ENGLISH
ENG
Timeshift Mode and press OK.
82
DVR Function
NOTE
Timeshift Progress
�
2
��
1
3
00:35
05:35
ꔄ Recording starts � Live TV � � ꕚ ꕙ � Recorded List � Rec./Schedule
� Hide
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
- As soon as Timeshift starts, a progress bar
indicating the current recording status is
displayed in the bottom of the screen.
- It Press the BACK button to hide the ‘Progress
Bar’ or press the OK button to display the
‘Progress Bar’.
- This function is preserved even though
changing a programme on progressing the
Timeshift.
ENGLISH
ENG
The ‘Progress Bar’?
This function indicates what Timeshift
reviewing is possible, a current on-screen
and live broadcasting position.
1
Preview
2
Current location and progress time in
playback
3
Total progress time of the Timeshift
Playback
Fast forward
Rewind
Pause
Direct view +
Direct view By one screen
Slow playback
yy
In order to save hard-disk space, nothing is
saved when there is no signal.
yy
Timeshift can be used for maximum of 2
hours.
yy
You can’t do the programme change or input
conversion on recording.
yy
When turning power on, it may take up to a
maximum of 3 minutes to initialize the HDD.
yy
Recording or playing the recorded programme may not initiate for a copy-protected
programme.
yy
Instant recording time is set to 3 hours and
supported maximum time is up to 5 hours.
yy
A thumbnail is created every 3 minutes for
recordings longer than 18 minutes and every
1 to 3 minutes for recordings shorter than 18
minutes.
yy
Up to 6 thumbnails are created on one
screen.
yy
DVR is available in DTV channel.
yy
Radio or some scramble programmes cannot
be recorded.
yy
You can record and enjoy DTV programmes
in 3D.
DVR Function
Playback during the Timeshift
During the Timeshift play, the following options
are available.
Use of remote control
You can playback the temporarily saved part in
various methods during the Timeshift.
83
RECORDING
Use this function when you cannot watch the desired programme due to being out.
Start/Stop record
You can record the programme you are watching.
Start record
Button
1 Press REC to start the recording.
Stop record
Recording in progress. Stop
recording?
!
Recording stop
Recording end time modify
Close
� Recording starts.
1 Press REC to stop the recording.
2 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to Recording
stop and press OK.
NOTE
yy
You can also stop the recording by pressing
STOP.
ENGLISH
ENG
Description
During playback,
repeatedly, press the REW ( ) or FF ( )
button to speed up.
time you press the button, the
- Every
search speed will increase by stage (up to
4 stages).
During playback,
press the Pause( ) button.
screen is displayed.
- Pause
time you press the Pause( ) button
- Every
from the pause screen, it will move screen
by screen ( ).
the Pause( ) button and then use
- Press
the FF ( ) button for slow motion ( ).
When you move the cursor using the navi, OK
gation ( ) button during playback, and
then press the OK button, the screen will
directly play at the applicable screen where
the cursor is located. (
)
LIVE TV To view the current live broadcast, press the
LIVE TV button during playback.
84
DVR Function
SCHEDULE
Modify recording end time
!
Manual Timer
Recording in progress. Stop
recording?
Recording stop
This function is easy to register to reserved recording. Timer recording is set.
Recording end time modify
Close
� Recording starts.
Free Space 100GB
� 79h 03m � 31h 37m
Record/Schedule
Select time to record.
Apr.2 2010 15:30
Going to the manual timer menu.
Start Time
10
:
37
End Time
13
:
37
Recorded List
Select schedule
by date
Schedule List
ꔄ Recording starts
OK
Cancel
1 Press REC to stop the recording.
Select schedule
by program
� Option
Exit
* Select schedule by program is not available in
New Zealand.
2 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to Recording
end time modify and press OK.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to set the
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
When recording, if the available storage
space is not sufficient, the recording will
automatically Stop.
yy
Recordings of less than 10 seconds will not
be saved.
yy
Recording available time is maximum 5
hours.
yy
To save disk space while recording broadcasts, no data will be saved if there is no
signal.
yy
The recording function will not initiate for a
copy-protected programme.
yy
The displayed time may differ slightly from
the actual time.
yy
When there is no signal or a film source is
being viewed, the displayed time may differ
slightly from the actual time.
Apr.2 2010 15:30
Select the date to schedule.
recording end time and press OK.
NOTE
Free Space 100GB
� 79h 03m � 31h 37m
Manual Timer
Sun.
Mon.
Tue.
Wed.
Thu.
Fri.
28
29
30
31
1
22
4
5
6
7
8
9
11
12
13
14
15
16
18
19
20
21
22
23
Sat.
Once
ꔡ
10
Weekly
(Fri.)
Mon. ~ Fri.
No schedule list
17
Cancel
24
Move
� Programme Guide
Apr.2 2010ꔉ
3
Daily
OK
� Schedule List
Exit
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to Select
schedule by date and press OK.
4 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to select a
date and press OK.
WARNING
yy
Broadcast materials are protected by copyright and that recording and playback of
certain material would only be permissible by
permission of the copyright owner.
yyAudio and video recordings you make using
this recorder are for your personal use only.
You may not sell, lend or rent them to other
people.
5 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to select
repeat option and press OK.
6 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to set the
schedule type, time and programme and press
OK.
7 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
DVR Function
Schedule List
Modify
This function is used to show scheduled programme. You can store up to 30 programmes.
Apr.2 2010 15:30
You can see the schedule list.
Recorded List
Select schedule
by date
Schedule List
Select schedule
by program
� Option
ꔄ Recording starts
Description
Edit the contents of Start date/
Start time/End time/Title/Repeat.
You must press the BACK button
to save the edited contents.
This feature is disabled in reserved
reminding.
Delete the selected item in the list.
Delete all items in the list.
Close the pop-up menu.
Delete
Delete All
Close
Free Space 100GB
� 79h 03m � 31h 37m
Record/Schedule
Menu
85
Exit
* Select schedule by program is not available in
New Zealand.
Schedule List Initialzation
This function is to reset the schedule list.
Timeshift Mode
Schedule List
Apr.2 2007 15:30
Page1/1
Start Date
Start Time
6 May 18:00 On
►
USB device Initialization
Friend2
16:00
Friend1
Close
Friend2
Modify
Modify
� Recording starts.
Delete
Delete All
Remind
DTV 19 Dave
(Fri.)06/05/2007
16:00
Close
ꔀ
� Manual Timer
Move
!
The schedule list is deleted after
initialization. To continue
initialization, select OK.
Modify/Delete
� Programme Guide
Exit
OK
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to Schedule
List and press OK.
4 Press Navigation buttons to select a desired
programme and press OK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
Cancel
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button to show the DVR option
menu and press Q.MENU.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
Schedule list Initialization and press OK.
4 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to OK and
press OK. Start the Schedule List Initialization.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
ENGLISH
ENG
16:00 ►
6 May Title
◄
Schedule list Initialization
86
DVR Function
Programme Guide
NOTE
yy
Recording is not possible with copy-protected programmes.
* Programme Guide is not available in New
Zealand.
This function is easy to register to reserved recording. (Refer to “EPG”)
Free Space 100GB
79h 03m
31h 37m
Record/Schedule
Apr.2 2010 15:30
Going to the manual timer menu.
Recorded List
Schedule List
Select schedule
by date
Recording starts
Select schedule
by program
Exit
Option
Programme Guide
▲
That ’70s show
25 Nov. 2008 10:05
DTV 1 YLE TV1 25 Nov. 2008 09:45~10:15
ALL
NOW
1 YLE TV1
NEXT
That ’70s show
ENGLISH
ENG
2 YLE TV2 Your World Today
4 TV..
Legenen om Den....
5 YLE FST Naturtimmen
6 CNN
Lyssna
INFO i Information
Mode
▼
Watch/Schedule
TV/
RAD
Manual Timer
Keno
World Business
Fantomen
Kritiskt
ABC
RADIO
Schedule List
Exit
FAV
Favourite
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Yellow button.
3 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to Select
schedule by program and press OK.
4 Press Navigation buttons to scroll to select a
programme and press OK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
Program with copy protection : failed to record.
yy
When a poor quality external source is
recorded the quality of the recording will not
be optimal.
yy
Manual Recording available time is maximum 5 hours and minimum 2 minutes.
yy
When broadcasting station send the wrong
time information, reserved recording may be
failed.
yy
If different programmes are set for the same
time for on time and reserved recording, this
TV is powered on to the reserved recording
programme.
yy
If you turn off the power during the recording, the programme being recorded may not
be saved. Therefore it is good to press the
STOP (�) button and check the reserved/recorded list, and then turn off the power.
yy
Recording cannot be reserved for a period
less than 10 seconds.
yy
Because the title and time of the programme
for Record/Remind is based on the information transmitted from the broadcasting
station, they may be different than the actual
ones depending on the situation of the
broadcasting station.
yy
Recording time may differ depending on
resolution of input signal or USB HDD capacity.
yy
When it is time for the reserved recording
to start and the power of the TV is turned
off, the TV will turn on the power of the part
required for the recording and proceed to the
reservation.
yy
When it is time for the reserved recording
to start and the Immediate recording is in
progress, the recording of the programme
currently being recorded will be stopped and
saved, and then proceed to the reserved
recording.
yy
If the TV is unplugged once or turn off, the
reserved recording will not work.
DVR Function
RECORDED TV
NOTE
You can view the recorded programme list at a
glance.
The recorded programme stored in the USB
device can be played.
Recorded TV List
�
��
00:35
05:35
ꔄ Recording starts � Live TV � � ꕚ ꕙ � Recorded List � Rec./Schedule
Recorded List
USB
USB1 XTICK
Play
ꕉ Hide
Page Change
Free Space 100GB
79h 03m
31h 37m
1/1 Page
D1
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
87
D2
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
D3
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
Exit
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Green button to select Recorded List.
3 Press Navigation buttons to recorded
programme and press OK.
4 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
ENGLISH
ENG
Mark Mode
y If there is a bad sector in the disk, part or
all of the items of the Recording list can be
deleted.
y Maximum number of recordings within the
Recording list is 200. When the number of
recordings in the Recording list is 200, you
cannot record any more.
y When the full duration of the recording is
played back, the screen will stay in the
stopped condition for 10 seconds and then
automatically end the playback.
y The recording can be played back even during the recording/reserved recording.
y During the playback of the recording, the
hard disk can generate a certain level of
noise.
y This noise is irrelevant from the performance
and reliability of the product and is normal for
a hard drive to have a certain level of noise.
y The programme recorded at other TV can’t
be played back in accordance with copyright
policy. If you attempt to play back the programme recorded at other TV, you will see a
black screen.
88
DVR Function
Mark Mode
Playing Recorded programmes
Play
Recorded List
USB
Page Change
Free Space 100GB
79h 03m
31h 37m
USB1 XTICK
Mark Mode 1/1 Page
D1
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
You can play a selected programme from the
recorded list.
D2
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
1
D3
Playing time 00:02:30 /Date:2010.01.01
2
3
��
00:35
05:35
� � � ꕚ ꕙ � Clip-Edit
� Unmark All
� Mark All
� Play Marked
� Delete Marked
� Repeat
� Option ꕉ Hide
Exit
Exit Mark Mode
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Green button to select Recorded List.
3 Press FAV to mark your desired recorded
programme.
4 Press Navigation buttons to select a desired
recorded programme.
5 Press Yellow button to play the marked
ENGLISH
ENG
recorded programme.
1 After connecting USB device, press the OK
button.
2 Press Green button to select Recorded List.
3 Press Navigation buttons to recorded
programme and press OK.
4 Press Green button to select Option and press
OK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
When you return to the previous menu, press
BACK.
Button
Red button
Description
Unmark All: Change marked recorded
programmes to unmarked recorded
programmes.
Green button
Mark All: Mark all recorded
programmes in the list.
Menu
Play on previous
Yellow button
Play Marked: Play the first selected
file. Once recorded programmes
finishes playing, the next selected one
will be played automatically.
playtime.
Play from the start Playback of selected recorded
programmes.
Blue button
Delete Marked: Delete the marked
recorded programmes.
FAV
Exit Mark Mode.
Rename
Delete
Description
Resumes playing at the previously
stopped point.
Rename the programme.
Delete the programme.
DVR Function
89
Use of remote control
The ‘Progress Bar’?
This function indicates what recorded programme reviewing is possible, a current
on-screen and live broadcasting position.
1
Preview
2
Current location and progress time in
playback
3
Total progress time of the recorded programme
Button
Green button
Yellow button
Blue button
, OK
3D (Only 3D
models)
Description
During playback,
repeatedly, press the REW ( ) or FF
( ) button to speed up.
- Every time you press the button, the
search speed will increase by stage
(up to 4 stages).
Option: Press Green button to input
video and audio settings for recorded
files.
Clip-Edit:
Press the Yellow button at the starting
point where you want to set the Interval
clip-edit and press it again at the ending
point. To save, select Yes.
- The start of the Interval clip-edit
is displayed as
and end of
the Interval clip-edit as
in the
recording progress bar at the bottom
of the screen. Start and end of the
Interval clip-edit can be set both in
forward and reverse direction.
- Interval shorter than 10 seconds
cannot be saved.
Repeat:
Press the Blue button at the starting
point where you want to set the
Interval repeat and press it again
at the ending point. To cancel the
playback for the interval repeat, press
the BLUE button one more time.
- The start of the Interval repeat
is displayed as
and end of
the Interval repeat as
in the
recording progress bar at the bottom
of the screen. Start and end of the
Interval repeat can be set both in
forward and reverse direction.
- Interval shorter than 10 seconds
cannot be set.
- When the Interval repeat is
cancelled, it will return to normal
playback from the end point of the
interval.
During playback, press the Pause( ) button.
- Pause screen is displayed.
- Every time you press the Pause( )
button from the pause screen, it will move
screen by screen ( ).
- Press the Pause( ) button and then use
the FF ( ) button for slow motion ( ).
- If you don’t press any button 10
minutes after the pause, it will return
to the playback.
When you move the cursor using the
navigation ( ) button during playback,
and then press the OK button, the
screen will directly play at the
applicable screen where the cursor is
located. (
)
Uses for viewing 3D video.
ENGLISH
ENG
Playback
Fast forward
Rewind
Pause
Direct view +
Direct view By one screen
Slow playback
(Blue) Start repeat interval
(Yellow) Start clip-edit interval
(Blue) End repeat interval
(Yellow) End clip-edit interval
Repeating interval
You can adjust various method during the recorded
programme play.
90
EPG (ELECTRONIC PROGRAMME GUIDE) (IN DIGITAL MODE)
EPG (Electronic Programme
Guide) Function (In digital
mode)
Tyra
DTV 18 The HITS
28 Sep. 2008 21:00~00:00
Record
Remind
Close
This feature is disabled in New Zealand.
This system has an Electronic Programme Guide
(EPG) to help your navigation through all the
possible viewing options.
The EPG supplies information such as programme
listings, start and end times for all available
services. In addition, detailed information about
the programme is often available in the EPG (the
availability and amount of these programme details
will vary, depending on the particular broadcaster).
OK
Record : A pop-up window for record settings
appear.
Remind : Reserved.
Select Timer Record/Remind setting mode.
This function can be used only when the EPG information is broadcast by broadcasting companies.
The EPG displays the programme details for next 8
days.
You must set the Clock in the Time menu, before using EPG function.
ENGLISH
ENG
DTV
18 The HITS
Movers and Shakers : 86-06
18:00
19:30
Next
Pr. Change
MHEG ... 4:3
Watch
Wed. 7 Feb. 19:28
576i
A look back at the hottest dance moves of the past 20 years.
yy
Press INFO to show current programme
information.
Displayed with a TV or DTV Programme.
Displayed with a Radio Programme.
HE-AAC C
Switch on/off EPG
Displayed with a MHEG Programme.
Displayed with a HE-AAC Programme.
Aspect ratio of broadcasting programme.
Aspect ratio of broadcasting programme.
Displayed with a Teletext Programme.
Displayed with a Subtitle Programme.
1 Press GUIDE to switch on or off EPG.
Select a programme
1 Press Navigation buttons or P
Programme Guide
Displayed with a Dolby Digital PLUS
Programme.
576i/p,
720p, Resolution of broadcasting programme
1080i/p
>
Shows next programme information.
Shows other programme information.
▲
That ’70s show
25 Nov. 2008 10:05
DTV 1 YLE TV1 25 Nov. 2008 09:45~10:15
ALL
NOW
1 YLE TV1
NEXT
That ’70s show
2 YLE TV2 Your World Today
4 TV..
Legenen om Den....
5 YLE FST Naturtimmen
6 CNN
Lyssna
Displayed with a Scramble Programme.
Displayed with a Dolby Digital Programme.
to select
desired programme.
INFO i Information
Mode
▼
Watch/Schedule
Manual Timer
TV/
RAD
Keno
World Business
Fantomen
Kritiskt
ABC
RADIO
Schedule List
Exit
FAV
Favourite
EPG (ELECTRONIC PROGRAMME GUIDE) (IN DIGITAL MODE)
NOW/NEXT Guide Mode
You can view a programme being broadcasted and
one scheduled to follow.
Button
Red button
Yellow button
Blue button
OK
Description
Change EPG mode.
Enter Manual Timer mode. (See p.84)
Enter Schedule List mode. (See p.85)
When ‘NOW’ is selected, it is moved to
selected programme and EPG disappears.
When ‘NEXT’ is selected, a reservation
pop-up window appears.
Select NOW or NEXT Programme.
Select the Broadcast Programme.
P
GUIDE
BACK
EXIT
TV/RAD
INFO
FAV
Page Up/Down.
Switch off EPG.
Select DTV or RADIO Programme.
Detail information on or off.
Change Favourite mode.
Date Change Mode
Button
Green button
v
BACK
OK
Switch off Date setting mode.
GUIDE
EXIT
Switch off EPG.
OK
Description
Change EPG mode.
Enter Date setting mode.
Enter Manual Timer mode.(See p.84)
Enter Schedule List mode.(See p.85)
When ‘Currently broadcasting programme is selected, it is moved to selected programme and EPG disappears
When ‘Future broadcasting programme
is selected, a reservation pop-up window
appears.
Select Programme.
Select the Broadcast Programme.
P
GUIDE
BACK
EXIT
TV/RAD
INFO
FAV
Page Up/Down.
Switch off EPG.
Select DTV or RADIO Programme.
Detail information on or off.
Change Favourite mode.
Change to the selected date.
Select a date.
Button
INFO
Description
The detail information on or off.
Text Up/Down.
Select Timer Record/Remind setting
mode.
Switch off EPG.
ENGLISH
ENG
Button
Red button
Green button
Yellow button
Blue button
Description
Extended Description Box
GUIDE
EXIT
8 Day Guide Mode
91
92
MHEG (MULTIMEDIA AND HYPERMEDIA INFORMATION CODING EXPERT GROUP) (IN DIGITAL MODE)
MHEG (Multimedia and
Hypermedia Information
coding Expert Group) (In
digital mode)
Teletext in Digital Service
1 Press the numeric or P
button to select
a certain service which broadcasts digital
teletext.
2 Press the TEXT or coloured button to switch on
This feature is not available for all country.
The TV gives you access to digital teletext which is
greatly improved in various aspects such as text,
graphics etc.
This digital teletext can access special digital teletext services and specific services which broadcast digital teletext.
teletext.
3 Follow the indications on digital teletext and
move onto the next step by pressing OK,
Navigation buttons, Red buttons, Green buttons, Yellow buttons, Blue buttons or NUMBER
buttons and so on.
4 Press the TEXT or colour button to switch off
digital teletext and return to TV viewing.
Teletext Within Digital Service
ENGLISH
ENG
1 Press the numeric or P
button to select a
digital service which broadcasts digital teletext.
2 Follow the indications on digital teletext and
move onto the next step by pressing TEXT,
OK, Navigation buttons, Red buttons, Green
buttons, Yellow buttons, Bluebuttons or
NUMBER buttons and etc.
3 To change digital teletext service, select a different service by the numeric or P
button.
Some services may allow you to access text
services by pressing the Red button.
MHEG (MULTIMEDIA AND HYPERMEDIA INFORMATION CODING EXPERT GROUP) (IN DIGITAL MODE)
This feature is enabled only in New Zealand.
- In New Zealand, pressing the Guide key will
display MHEG EPG provided by New Zealand on the screen.
This system has an MHEG(Multimedia and hypermedia information coding expert group) to help
your navigation through all the possible viewing
options.
DTV
18 The HITS
Movers and Shakers : 86-06
18:00
19:30
Next
Pr. Change
Watch
93
Select a programme
1 Press Navigation buttons to preview the Broadcast Programme Information.
2 Press Navigation buttons to change to desired
channel.
3 Press OK to remove MHEG after moving to a
selected channel.
Wed. 7 Feb. 19:28
MHEG ... 4:3 576i
A look back at the hottest dance moves of the past 20 years.
yy
Press INFO to show current programme
information.
Next Week
EPG/Guide
Displayed with a TV or DTV Programme.
Displayed with a MHEG Programme.
HE-AAC C Displayed with a HE-AAC Programme.
Aspect ratio of broadcasting programme.
Aspect ratio of broadcasting programme.
Programme Listing Mode
Button
Displayed with a Teletext Programme.
Yellow button
Blue button
Displayed with a Subtitle Programme.
OK
Displayed with a Scramble Programme.
GUIDE
BACK
INFO
Displayed with a Dolby Digital Programme.
Displayed with a Dolby Digital PLUS
Programme.
576i/p,
720p, Resolution of broadcasting programme
1080i/p
>
Shows next programme information.
Shows other programme information.
NOW/NEXT Guide Mode
You can view a channel being broadcasted and
one scheduled to follow.
Button
Switch on/off MHEG
1 Press GUIDE to switch on or off MHEG.
Description
Select the Broadcast Programme
Information.
Select Channel.
Change to Next Week or Previous Day.
Change to Next Day or Today.
The MHEG will disappear after
moving to a selected channel.
Change to Now/Next mode.
Switch off MHEG.
Detail information on or off.
OK
GUIDE
BACK
INFO
Description
Select desired channel.
The MHEG will disappear after moving
to a selected channel.
Change to Listing mode.
Switch off MHEG.
Detail information on or off.
ENGLISH
ENG
Displayed with a Radio Programme.
94
3D IMAGING
3D IMAGING (ONLY
3D MODELS)
3D Technology
This TV can display in 3D via 3D broadcasting or
when the TV is connected to a compatible device,
such as a Blu-ray 3D Player. The viewer must
wear compatible 3D glasses in order to see these
images in 3D format.
WARNING
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
We recommend that you maintain a distance
of at least twice the screen diagonal length
when watching 3D videos.
yy
To watch the TV in 3D, you must put on your
3D glasses. For best results, you should
wear LG Brand 3D glasses. The 3D imaging
may not display properly when using another
brand of 3D glasses. Please see the 3D
glasses manual for instructions on how to
use the 3D glasses.
yy
When watching 2D images, it is recommended to take off the 3D glasses. If you watch
2D images with the 3D glasses on, you may
see distorted images.
yy
If you watch the 3D imaging too closely or
for a long period of time, it may harm your
eyesight.
yy
Watching the TV or playing video games that
incorporate 3D imaging with the 3D glasses
for a long period of time can cause drowsiness, headaches or fatigue to you and/or
your eyes. If you have a headache, or otherwise feel fatigued or drowsy, stop watching
the TV and have a rest.
yy
Pregnant woman, seniors, persons with
heart problems or persons who experience
frequent drowsiness should refrain from
watching 3D TV.
yy
Some 3D imaging may cause you to duck
or dodge the image displayed in the video.
Therefore, it is best if you do not watch 3D
TV near fragile objects or near any objects
that can be knocked over easily.
yy
Please prevent children under the age of 5
from watching 3D TV. It may affect their vision development.
yy
Warning for photosensitization seizure:
Some viewers may experience a seizure or
epilepsy when exposed to certain factors,
including flashing lights or images in TV or
video games. If you or anybody from your
family has a history of epilepsy or seizure,
please consult with your doctor before
watching 3D TV.
Also certain symptoms can occur in unspecified conditions without any previous history.
If you experience any of the following symptoms, immediately stop watching the 3D
imaging and consult a doctor: dizziness or
light-headedness, visual transition or altered
vision, visual or facial instability, such as eye
or muscle twitching, unconscious action,
convulsion, loss of conscience, confusion
or disorientation, loss of directional sense,
cramps, or nausea. Parents should monitor
their children, including teenagers, for these
symptoms as they may be more sensitive to
the effects of watching 3D TV.
yy
Risk of photosensitization seizure can be
reduced with the following actions.
» Take frequent breaks from watching 3D
TV.
»F
or those who have vision that is different in each eye, they should watch the TV
after taking vision correction measures.
»W
atch the TV so that your eyes are on the
same level as the 3D screen and refrain
from sitting too closely to the TV.
»D
o not watch the 3D imaging when tired
or sick, and avoid watching the 3D imaging for a long period of time.
»D
o not wear the 3D glasses for any other
purpose than viewing 3D imaging on a 3D
TV.
»S
ome viewers may feel disoriented after
watching 3D TV. Therefore, after you
watch 3D TV, take a moment to regain
awareness of your situation before moving.
3D IMAGING
NOTE
(Only 47/55LW77**, 47/55LZ96**, 50/60PZ57**,
50PZ65**, 50/60PZ95**)
yy
After powering on the TV, a few seconds
may be needed for your TV to calibrate.
yy
If there is an obstacle between the TV and
the 3D glasses, the 3D imaging may not
display properly.
yy
Do not use the TV in close proximity to other
electronic equipments and RF equipments.
yy
The 3D imaging may not display if it is
viewed while you are lying down.
yy
It may take a moment for you to see the
3D imaging if you look away from the TV
and then revert your eyes back to the 3D
programme.
yy
The TV may flicker slightly if the 3D imaging
is displayed under fluorescent. In such instances, it is recommended to turn the lights
off or to dim the lights. (Only Plasma TV)
yy
If 3D TV broadcast standard changes in the
future and it is not supported by this TV set,
you may need a separate device, such as a
set-top-box.
When using 3D Glasses
CAUTION
yy
Do not use the 3D glasses to replace your
corrective glasses, sunglasses or protective
goggles.
yy
Do not store the 3D glasses in hot or cold
locations.
yy
Do not drop objects onto the 3D glasses. Do
not drop or bend the glasses.
yy
Since the lenses of the 3D glasses are
easily scratched, make sure to clean only
with a soft cloth. Shake off any dust before
using the cloth since the glasses are easily
scratched.
yy
A communication failure may occur if the
glasses are near electronic devices that use
the same bandwidth (2.4 GHz), such as a
microwave oven or wireless LAN product.
ENGLISH
ENG
NOTE
95
96
3D IMAGING
3D Imaging viewing range
Viewing 3D Imaging
(Only 47/55LW77**, 47/55LZ96**, 50/60PZ57**,
50PZ65**, 50/60PZ95**)
TV size, viewing angle & other circumstances may
change the viewing distance and the angle of view.
1 Play the video produced in 3D.
Viewing Distance
2 m to 7 m
Maximum Viewing
Distance
10 m
2 Press 3D to watch 3D imaging.
3 Wear the 3D glasses.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll the OK
and press OK.
5 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the
shape and press OK. (See "3D supported
mode")
Mode
2D 3D
Description
Changed from 2D imaging to
3D imaging.
2D-to-3D converted videos
may appear less realistic than
titles originally produced as 3D
videos.
Side by Side
ENGLISH
ENG
Top & Bottom
Checker Board
Frame Sequential
6 Press 3D button to 2D Off or 3D Off.
Option
3D → 2D
3D Off
2D → 3D
Cancel
Description
Displays images in 2D without
any 3D effects.
Displays images in original
format.
Displays images in 3D.
Close the pop-up window.
3D IMAGING
Setting 3D Imaging
1 Press the 3D OPTION while viewing 3D
imaging. A pop-up window will appears.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one
of the following options and press OK.
97
Set Video.
Allows you to change Video settings. (Refer to
“PICTURE Settings”).
Set Audio.
Allows you to change Audio settings. (Refer to
“AUDIO Settings”).
Choose options.
3D Mode Setting
Set Video.
Set Audio.
Close
3D Mode Setting
Option
(Depending on
model)
3D Picture
Correction
3D Depth
3D Viewpoint
3D Picture
Balance
3D Optimization
Cuts off the outer edges of the
picture and stretch it to fit the full
screen in 3D mode.
Select Left/Right or Right/Left.
Select the screen with 3D video
with bettter visibility.
Adjusts the stereoscopic effect of
the 3D image converted from a 2D
image.
Moves the 3D image to the front
and back to adjust the 3D perspective view.
Adjusts the colour and brightness
difference between the right and
left sides of the picture in 3D mode.
Optimizes the 3D image screen for
the viewing environment.
yy
Some menus may not work while viewing 3D
imaging.
yy
The 3D imaging mode is disabled automatically when switching DTV channels, input
source.
yy
The screen may not be displayed properly if
you view 2D images in 3D imaging mode.
yy
3D effect can be seen when 3D Mode is
selected appropriately for the 3D input signal
supplied to the TV.
yy
For *mpo files (3D camera files), the 3D
imaging mode is enabled automatically.
yy
While viewing 3D image in USB, Slide Show
is not supported.
NOTE
yy
If you select 3D mode, “Power indicator” is
turned off automatically.
yy
You can only choose “Off or Cinema” with
the AV MODE button on the remote control.
yy
Energy Saving is disabled while playing in
3D.
yy
You cannot enter the Home menu while
watching 3D files.
ENGLISH
ENG
3D Picture Size
Description
CAUTION
98
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
CUSTOMIZING TV SETTINGS
The SETUP Menu
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to select the SETUP menu and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of the following menus and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option you want and press OK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
Menu
ENGLISH
ENG
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
Description
SETUP
Sets up and edit programmes.
PICTURE
Adjusts the image size, quality, or effect.
AUDIO
Adjusts the sound quality, effect, or volume level.
TIME
Sets the time, date, or timer feature.
LOCK
Locks or unlocks channels and programmes.
OPTON
Customizes the general settings.
NETWORK
Sets up the network setting.
SUPPORT
Checks the customer information.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
99
Customizing Settings
SETUP Settings
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
SETUP
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
●
Auto Tuning
●
Manual Tuning
●
Programme Edit
Move
OK
Exit
OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available programme settings are described in the following:
Setting
Description
Tunes and stores all available programmes through antennas inputs (See p.38).
Manual Tuning
Tunes and stores the programmes you want manually (See p.38).
Programme Edit
Edits programmes (See p.40).
ENGLISH
ENG
Auto Tuning
100
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
PICTURE Settings
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
PICTURE
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to PICTURE and press
●
Aspect Ratio
●
Set 3D Video
●
Picture Wizard
●
ꕊ
●
Picture Mode
Move
Exit
OK
: 16:9
Energy Saving : Off
OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
: Standard
● Backlight
70
● Contrast
100
● Brightness
50
● Sharpness
70
● Colour
60
● Tint
0
R
G
● Colour Temp.
0
W
C
● Advanced Control
● Picture Reset
●
TruMotion
: Low
●
Screen
●
LED Local Dimming: Low
The available picture settings are described in the following.
Setting
Description
ENGLISH
ENG
Aspect Ratio
Changes the image size to view images at its optimal size (See p.42).
Set 3D Video
(Only 3D models)
Sets the 3D imaging option. (See p.96)
Picture Wizard
Adjusts the image quality and calibrates the screen.
The customized options will be saved as Expert1 in the Picture Mode.
NOTE
y If you stop the setting before the final stage, the changes will not be applied.
y If you use Picture Wizard, the Energy saving feature will turn off automatically.
y To reset changes made by Picture Wizard, operate Picture Reset when Picture Mode
is on Expert1.
y In RGB-PC/HDMI-PC/DVI-PC mode, the changed Colour, Tint and H/V Sharpness
values are not applied.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Energy Saving
101
Description
Reduces the power consumption by adjusting the screen brightness.
Option (Depending on model)
Auto
The backlight is adjusted automatically corresponding to the surroundings
when selecting Auto using the Intelligent sensor feature.
Intelligent sensor The most suitable picture is automatically adjusted corresponding to the
surroundings.
Off
The Energy Saving is off.
Minimum
/Medium
/Maximum
Selects the brightness level.
Screen off
The screen turns off in 3 seconds.
Pressing any button of the remote control will turn on the screen again.
NOTE
yy
When adjusting Energy Saving in MHEG mode, the Energy Saving setting is applied
after MHEG is finished.
yySelecting ‘Screen Off’ while tuned to a radio station channel will reduce power consumption.
yyWhen selecting Auto or Maximum, Backlight feature will not work.
ENGLISH
ENG
102
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Picture Mode
Description
Selects one of the preset image or customizes options in each mode for the best TV screen performance. You are also able to customize advanced options of each mode.
The available preset picture modes vary depending on the TV.
NOTE
If you adjust “Picture Mode-THX Cinema, THX Bright Room”, “Energy Savingyy
Intelligent Sensor, Minimum, Medium, Maximum” feature will not work.
yyIf you adjust “Picture Mode-APS”, “Energy Saving-Off, Minimum, Medium, Maximum”
feature will not work.
yyIf you selecting THX Cinema or THX Bright, the option of the Aspect Ratio feature will
switch to Just scan automatically.
Mode (Depending on model)
ENGLISH
ENG
Intelligent sensor
Sets the TV to adjust the image settings, such as contrast, brightness,
sharpness, colour, or tint, automatically corresponding to the surrounding
environments.
Vivid
Adjusts the video image for the retail environment by enhancing the contrast, brightness, colour, and sharpness.
Standard
Adjusts the image for the normal environment.
APS (Auto Power
Saving)
Maximize reducing the power consumption without hurting the picture
quality.
Cinema
Optimizes the video images for a cinematic look to enjoy movies as if you
are in a movie theatre.
THX Cinema
THX Bright Room
Provides the experience of watching a movie at home. The user will be able
enjoy the best level of satisfactory screen quality in any movie without any
separate adjustments.
yyTHX Cinema express the optimal screen quality when it is darkest.
yyTHX Bright Room express the optimal screen quality when it is
brightest.
NOTE
»»THX : THX (Thomlinson Holman’s Experiment) is an audio and video
certification standard established by George Lucas and Thomlinson.
A THX certified display guarantees screen quality that exceeds the
display standard specification in both hardware and software.
Sport
Optimizes the video image for high and dynamic actions by emphasizing
primary colours such as white, grass, or sky blue.
Game
Optimizes the video image for a fast gaming screen for PCs or games.
Photo
Optimizes the still image like a photo file (ie, when connecting the external
device like a DSLR)
Expert1/Expert2
Adjusts the detailed video image settings for video experts as well as general viewers.
NOTE
yy
ISFccc (ISFccc: Imaging Science Foundation Certified Calibration
Control) : This TV contains the detailed calibrations necessary for
professional certification by the Imaging Science Foundation. The resulting ISF “day” and “night” modes will then be accessible by the user
to experience the best their LG HDTV has to offer.
Sophisticated and detailed calibrations can be made through the
ISFccc mode.
Detailed calibration requires a licensed technician. Please contact your
local dealer to inquire about an ISF certified technician.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
103
Description
TruMotion
*This feature is not available for all models.
(Only LED LCD TV) Advance video technology that provides clearer, smoother images, even during fast action scenes
creating a more stable structure for a crisper picture.
TruMotion works with all inputs except PC mode.
NOTE
yyIf you enable “TruMotion”, noise may appear on the screen. If this occurs, set “TruMotion” to “Off”.
yyIf you select “Picture Mode-Game ”, set “TruMotion” to “Off”.
Mode
SCREEN
High
Provides smoother picture movement.
Low
Provides smooth picture movement. Use this setting for standard use.
Off
Turn off TruMotion operation.
User
User can adjust Judder and Blur level in TruMotion Operation, separately.
De-Judder
Adjusts noise of the screen.
De-Blur
Adjusts after-image of the screen.
Customizes the PC display options.
Option
Selects a proper resolution when your PC uses.
Auto Configure
Sets the TV to optimize the options automatically for the TV display.
Position
Locates the image at the proper position.
Size
Adjusts the image size.
Phase
Eliminates horizontal streaking.
Reset
Restores the options to the default setting.
LED Local Dim*This feature is not available for all models.
ming
After analysing the signal of the input video by areas of the screen, it adjusts the backlight to
(Only LED LCD TV) improve the contrast ratio.
Mode
Off
Turn off LED Local Dimming operation.
Low
Brightens the picture and deepens black levels using the soft local dimming.
Medium
Deepens black levels using the strong local dimming.
High
Clears the picture and deepens black levels using the strong local dimming.
ENGLISH
ENG
Resolution
104
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Basic image options
Setting
Backlight
(Only LED LCD TV)
Description
Adjusts the brightness of the screen by controlling the LCD backlight. If you decrease the
brightness level, the screen becomes darker and the power consumption will be reduced without any video signal loss.
NOTE
yyIf you use the “Energy saving - Off, Minimum, Medium”, Backlight will be available.
Contrast
Increases or decreases the gradient of the video signal. You may use Contrast when the
bright part of the picture is saturated.
Brightness
Adjusts the base level of the signal in the picture.
Sharpness
Adjusts the level of crispness in the edges between the light and dark areas of the picture.
The lower the level, the softer the image.
Colour
Adjusts intensity of all colours.
Tint
Adjusts the balance between red and green levels.
Colour Temp.
Set to warm to enhance hotter colours such as red, or set to cool to enhance cooler colours
such as blue.
Advanced Control or
Expert Control
Customizes the advanced options.
Picture Reset
Restores the options of each mode to the factory default.
NOTE
yy
It is not available to use this function in Intelligent Sensor, THX Cinema, THX Bright Room.
ENGLISH
ENG
yyYou cannot adjust colour, sharpness and tint in the RGB-PC/HDMI-PC mode.
yyWhen the Expert 1/2 is selected, you can select Backlight, Contrast, Brightness, H Sharpness, V Sharpness,
Colour or Tint.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
105
Advanced image options (Depending on model)
Setting
Description
Dynamic Contrast
Adjusts the contrast to keep it at the best level according to the brightness of the screen. The
picture is improved by making bright parts brighter and dark parts darker.
Dynamic Colour
Adjusts screen colours so that they look livelier, richer and clearer. This feature enhances
hue, saturation and luminance so that red, blue and green white look more vivid.
Clear White
Make the white area of screen brighter and more white.
Skin Colour
It detects the skin area of video and adjusts it to express a natural skin colour.
Noise Reduction
Reduces screen noise without compromising video quality.
Super Resolution
Provides a crystal-clear picture by improving the details in an area that has a blurry or unclear
picture.
MPEG Noise Reduc- Removes noise caused by compressing video.
tion
Gamma
You can adjust brightness of dark area and middle gray level area of the picture.
»»Low: Make the dark and middle gray level areas brighter.
»»Medium: Express the original picture level.
»»High: Make the dark and middle gray level area darker.
ets black level of the screen to proper level. This function is available in the following
S
modes: AV (NTSC-M), HDMI or Component.
»»Auto: Sets black level of the screen to High or Low automatically according to the input
signal level.
»»Low: The reflection of the screen gets darker.
»»High: The reflection of the screen gets brighter.
Eye Care
Adjusts the brightness of the screen to prevent the screen from being too bright. Dims extremely bright pictures.
This feature is enabled in “Picture Mode-Standard, Game”.
Film Mode or Real
Cinema
Makes video clips recorded in film look more natural by eliminating judder effect.
Uses this function when you watch film-originated movie contents.
This function can also work when TruMotion is off.
Colour Gamut
LED LCD TV
Advanced Control
»» Maximizes the utilization of colour to increase colour quality.
»» Standard: Displays standard set of colours.
»» Wide: Increase number of colours used.
Expert Control
Displays colour domain of the signal.
»» Standard: Displays standard set of colours.
»» Wide: Increase number of colours used.
»» EBU: Mode to display EBU standard colour area.
»» SMPTE: Mode to display SMPTE standard colour area.
»» BT709: Mode to display BT709 standard colour area.
Plasma TV
Advanced Control, Expert Control
»» Maximizes the utilization of colour to increase colour quality.
»» Standard: Displays standard set of colours.
»» Wide: Increase number of colours used.
Photo mode
»» Wide: Increase number of colours used.
»» sRGB: Mode to display sRGB standard color gamut.
Edge Enhancer
Shows clearer and distinctive yet natural edges of the video.
This function works well over Sharpness UI 60 value.
xvYCC
This is produces richer colours.
This feature represents rich colours as much as a conventional video signal.
This function is enabled in “Picture mode - Cinema, Expert” when xvYCC signal is inputted
through HDMI.
Colour Filter
This is the function to filter the specific colours of the video.
You can use the RGB filter to set colour saturation and hue accurately.
Expert Pattern
This is the pattern used for expert adjustment
This function is enabled in “Picture Mode - Expert” when you watch DTV.
ENGLISH
ENG
Black Level
106
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Advanced image options (Depending on model)
Setting
Colour Temperature
ENGLISH
ENG
Colour Management
System
Description
Adjusts the overall colour of the screen by changing the white baseline.
LED
LCD TV
a. Method : 2 Points
yyPattern: Inner, Outer
yyRed/Green/Blue Contrast, Red/Green/Blue Brightness: The adjustment range
is -50 to +50.
b. Method : 10 Point IRE
yyPattern: Inner, Outer
yyIRE (Institute of Radio Engineers) is the unit to display the size of the video
signal and can be set among 10, 20, 30 to 100. You can adjust Red, Green or
Blue according to each setting.
yyLuminance: This function displays calculated luminance value for 2.2 gamma.
You can input luminance value you want at 100 IRE, than the target luminance
value for 2.2 gamma is displayed at every 10 steps from 10 IRE to 90 IRE.
yyRed/Green/Blue: The adjustment range is -50 to +50.
c. Apply to all inputs
Plasma
TV
a. Method : 2 Points
yyPattern: Inner, Outer
yyRed/Green/Blue Contrast, Red/Green/Blue Brightness: The adjustment range
is -50 to +50.
b. Method : 20 Point IRE
yyPattern: Inner, Outer
yyIRE (Institute of Radio Engineers) is the unit to display the size of the video
signal and can be set among 5, 10, 15 to 100. You can adjust Red, Green or
Blue according to each setting.
yyRed/Green/Blue: The adjustment range is -50 to +50.
c. Apply to all inputs
As the tool used by the experts to make adjustments by using the test patterns, this does
not affect other colours but can be used to selectively adjust the 6 colour areas (Red/Green/
Blue/ Yellow/Cyan/Magenta).
Colour difference may not be distinctive even when you make the adjustments for the general video.
Adjusts Red/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan, Magenta.
yyRed/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan, Magenta Colour: The adjustment range is -30 to +30.
yyRed/Green/Blue/Yellow/Cyan, Magenta Tint: The adjustment range is -30 to +30.
This feature is disabled in RGB-PC and HDMI-PC mode.
107
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
AUDIO Settings
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
AUDIO
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
● Auto
Volume
● Clear
Voice II
Move
: Off
: Off
ꕅ
● Balance
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to AUDIO and press
● Sound
Mode
option you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
The available audio settings are described in the following.
Setting
0
L
R
: Standard
• Treble
50
• Bass
50
• Sound Reset
● Sound
Optimizer
● Digital
Audio Out
● TV
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
2
• Infinite 3D Surround: Off
OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or
Exit
OK
Speaker
: Normal
: PCM
: On
● ARC
Mode
: Off
● DTV
Audio Setting
: Auto
● AV
Sync.
: Off
Description
Activates the Auto Volume feature to keep the volume level consistent whenever you change
channels. The volume level may not be consistent due to different signal conditions of broadcasting
stations.
Clear Voice
Sets whether to enhance human voice clarity. You can adjust the level of clarity when you set this
feature on.
Balance
Adjust balance between the left and right speakers according to your room environment.
Sound Mode
Selects one of the preset sound modes or customizes options in each mode.
NOTE
y If sound quality or volume is not at the level you want, it is recommended to use a separate
home theatre system or amplifier to cope with different user environments.
y If you select “On” for Clear Voice II, Infinite 3D Surround feature will not work.
Mode
Standard
Select when you want standard-quality sound.
Music
Select when you listen to music.
Cinema
Select when you watch movies.
Sport
Select when you watch sports events.
Game
Select when you play games.
Option
Infinite 3D
Surround
Patents LG proprietary sound processing technology that strives immersive
5.1 surround sound with just two front speakers.
Treble
Controls the dominant sounds in the output. When you turn up the treble, it
will increase the output to the higher frequency range.
Bass
Controls the softer sounds in the output. When you turn up the bass, it will
increase the output to the lower frequency range.
Sound Reset
Resets the sound mode to the default setting.
ENGLISH
ENG
Auto Volume
108
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Sound
Optimizer
Description
Optimizes the sound depending on the environment in which the TV is installed.
Option
Normal
Normal sound mode.
Wall Mount Type Optimized sound mode for a wall-mounted TV.
Stand Type
Digital Audio
Out
Item
Auto
PCM
TV Speaker
Optimized sound mode for a stand-type TV.
This function allows you to select your preferred Digital Audio Output.
When Dolby Digital is available, selecting Auto in the Digital Audio Out menu will set SPDIF(Sony
Philips Digital InterFace) output to Dolby Digital.
If Auto is selected in the digital audio out menu when Dolby Digital is not available, SPDIF output will
be PCM(Pulse-code modulation).
Even if both Dolby Digital and Audio language have been set in a channel which broadcast Dolby
Digital Audio, only Dolby Digital will be played.
Audio Input
Digital Audio output
MPEG
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital Plus
HE-AAC
PCM
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital
All
PCM
Turns on the internal speaker of the TV when using an external Hi-Fi system. You can use the TV
speaker as an audio output device even if there is no video input.
NOTE
ENGLISH
ENG
ARC Mode
(Audio Return
Channel)
yyWhen the TV speaker is turned off while the Simplink home theatre is operating, the sound output automatically switches to the Home theatre speaker, but when the TV speaker is turned on, the sound output the TV speaker.
yySome menus in AUDIO are disabled when TV speaker is set to Off.
When using an external audio device with the ARC (Audio Return Channel) feature, SPDIF can be
output using only a High Speed HDMI cable without an additional optical cable.
NOTE
yySome HDMI cables may not support this mode. (A High Speed HDMI cable is recommended.)
yyThe ARC mode only works for HDMI 1 (Only LED LCD TV) or HDMI 3 (Only Plasma TV)
input on the TV.
yyActivates the SIMPLINK feature to use this feature.
Option
On
If the device with the ARC feature is turned on, the device speaker is automatically used when SIMPLINK is enabled.
Off
Even if the device with the ARC feature is turned on and SIMPLINK is enabled,
the device speaker is not automatically used.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
DTV Audio Setting (In digital
mode only)
AV Sync
109
Description
When different audio types exist in an input signal, this function allows you to select the audio type
you want.
Mode
Auto
Automatically outputs in the order HE-AAC > Dolby Digital+ > Dolby Digital >
MPEG or Dolby Digital+ > Dolby Digital > HE-AAC > MPEG.
HE-AAC,
Dolby Digital+,
Dolby Digital,
MPEG
Allows users to select the audio type they want.
ex) If MPEG is selected, MPEG is always outputted.
If MPEG is not supported, another audio type is set in that order.
If the video and sound are not synced, you can adjust it manually.
(-) setting : Make audio output faster than the default.
(+) setting : Make audio output slower than the default.
Option
AV Sync.
Adjusts the sync of the TV speaker and SPDIF.
TV Speaker
Adjusts the sync of the sound from the TV's internal speaker.
SPDIF (Sony
Philips Digital
InterFace)
Adjusts the sync of the sound from an external speaker connected to the digital
audio output port.
ENGLISH
ENG
110
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
This feature may not be applied based on country broadcasting circumstance.
Stereo/Dual Reception (In Analogue Mode Only)
When a programme is selected, the sound information for the station appears with the programme
number and station name.
1 Press Q. MENU.
2 Press the Navigation to access the Audio or Audio Language and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation button to scroll to sound output and press OK.
Broadcast
On Screen Display
Mono
Stereo
Dual
MONO
STEREO
DUAL I , DUAL II , DUAL I + II
NICAM
NICAM
yy
Mono sound selection
If the stereo signal is weak in stereo reception, you can switch to mono. In mono reception, the clarity of
sound is improved.
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Language selection for dual language broadcast
If a programme can be received in two languages (dual language), you can switch to DUAL I,
DUAL II or DUAL I+II.
DUAL I DUAL I I DUAL I+I I Sends the primary broadcast language to the loudspeakers.
Sends the secondary broadcast language to the loudspeakers.
Sends a separate language to each loudspeaker.
Nicam Reception (In Analogue Mode Only)
If the TV is equipped with a receiver for NICAM reception, high quality NICAM (Near Instantaneous
Companding Audio Multiplex) digital sound can be received.
Sound output can be selected according to the type of broadcast received.
1 When NICAM mono is received, you can select NICAM MONO or FM MONO.
2 When NICAM stereo is received, you can select NICAM STEREO or FM MONO.
If the stereo signal is weak, switch to FM MONO.
3 When NICAM dual is received, you can select NICAM DUAL I, NICAM DUAL II or NICAM DUAL I+II or
FM MONO.
Speaker Sound Output Selection
In AV, Component, RGB and HDMI mode, you can select output sound for the left and right loudspeakers.
Select the sound output.
L+R: Audio signal from audio L input is sent to the left loudspeaker and audio signal from audio R input is
sent to the right loudspeaker.
L+L: Audio signal from audio L input is sent to left and right loudspeakers.
R+R: Audio signal from audio R input is sent to left and right loudspeakers.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
TIME Settings
111
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
TIME
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to TIME and press
Move
OK
Exit
● Clock
● Off
Time
: Off
● On
Time
: Off
● Sleep
Timer
: Off
OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available time settings are described in the following
Setting
Clock
Description
Sets the time, date, time zone and daylight-saving time feature.
The time will be set automatically according to a digital channel signal which includes time
information provided by the broadcasting station. If not, set the time and date manually.
Time Zone is enabled only in Australia, Indonesia and Israel only.
y < Only Australia > When you select a Time Zone city, the TV time is set by the time offset
information based on Time Zone and GMT (Greenwich Mean Time) which is received with
the broadcast signal and the time is set automatically by a digital signal.
y <Only Indonesia, Israel> GMT (Greenwich Mean Time) which is received with the broadcast
signal and the time is set automatically by a digital signal.
y When if the city name in Time Zone is changed into offset, you can change time by 1 hour.
y Time Zone menu can be changed in Auto mode.
Off Time/On
Time
Sets the time to turn on or off the TV automatically. To use this function, you should set the current
time and date in advance.
NOTE
y If you do not press any button within 2 hours after the TV turns on by the On Time feature,
the TV enters the Standby mode automatically.
y If you set both Off time and On time features to the same time, the Off time feature
overrides the On time feature.
Sleep Timer
Sets the length of time until the TV to turns off. When you turn the TV off and turn it on again, the
Sleep timer feature will be set to off.
ENGLISH
ENG
NOTE
112
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
LOCK Settings
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
LOCK
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
● Set
Move
OK
Exit
Password
● Lock
System
: Off
● Block Programme
● Parental Guidance : Off
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to LOCK and press OK.
● Input Block
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available lock settings are described in the following.
Setting
Description
ENGLISH
ENG
Set Password
Changes the 4-digit password. The default PIN is ‘0’,‘0’,‘0’,‘0’.
If you forget your password, press ‘0’, ‘3’,‘2’, ‘5’ on the remote control handset.
Lock System
Activates or deactivates the lock system.
Block
Programme
Blocks the programmes that contain inappropriate contents for children. The programmes can be
selected but the screen blank and the audio is muted.
To watch a locked programme, enter the password.
It is available to use this function in Lock System ”On”.
Parental
Guidance
This function operates according to information from the broadcasting station. Therefore if the signal
has incorrect information, this function does not operate.
A password is required to gain access to this menu.
This set is programmed to remember which option it was last set to even if you switch the set off.
Prevents children from watching certain adult’s TV programmes, according to the ratings limit set.
Enter a password to watch a blocked programme.
Rating differs by country.
Input Block
Block the input sources.
It is available to use this function in Lock System ”On”.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
OPTION Settings
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to OPTION and press
OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
113
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
OPTION
Move
OK
Exit
● Language(Language)
● Country
● Hard
: Australia
of Hearing (
● Power
)
: Off
Indicator
● Pointer
● Smart
Share Setting
● Factory
● Set
● Mode
● IR
Reset
ID
:1
Setting
Blaster
: Home Use
: Off
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available general settings are described in the following:
ENGLISH
ENG
114
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Language
(Language)
Description
Selects a language for the display or audio.
Option
Menu Language
Select your desired language.(Except for Australia, New Zealand,
Singapore and South Africa.)
Audio Language
(In Digital mode only)
The Audio function allows selection of a preferred language.
If audio data in a selected language is not broadcast, the default language
audio will be played.
Audio Language OSD Information
Display
N.A
Status
Not Available
MPEG Audio
Dolby Digital Audio
Audio for “Visual Impaired”
Audio for “Hearing Impaired”
Dolby Digital Plus Audio
HE-AAC Audio
Subtitle Language
(In Digital mode only)
Use the Subtitle function when two or more subtitle languages are
broadcast. If subtitle data in a selected language is not broadcast, the
default language subtitle will be displayed.
ENGLISH
ENG
Subtitle Language OSD Information
Display
N.A
Status
Not Available
Teletext Subtitle
Subtitle for “Hard of Hearing”
Text Language
(In Digital mode only)
In Digital mode, use the Text language function when two or more Text
languages are broadcast. If teletext data in a selected language is not
broadcast, the default Text language will be displayed.
If you select the wrong local country, teletext may not appear correctly on
the screen and some problems may occur during teletext operation.
NOTE
yyWhen the languages you selected as the primary for Audio Language and Subtitle Language
and Text Language are not supported, you can select language in secondary category (Only
New Zealand).
yyThe audio/subtitles can be displayed in a simpler form with 1 to 3 characters broadcast by
the service provider.
yyWhen you select supplementary Audio (Audio for “Visual/Hearing Impaired”) the TV may
output a part of the Main audio.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Description
Country (Only
Australia & New
Zealand)
Selects a desired country.
Hard of Hearing
(ꔞ) (In Digital
mode only)
This function if for the hearing impaired.
- It is only available to use Hard of Hearing on some TV stations in New Zealand.
Power Indicator
(Only LED LCD
TV)
Sets to turn on or off the indicator light on the TV.
If you select 3D mode, Power indicator is turned off automatically.
ISM Method
(Only Plasma TV)
115
Option
Standby Light
Set to turn on or off the indicator light in Standby mode.
Power Light
Set to turn on or off the indicator light when you turn on the power.
A frozen or still picture displayed on the screen for prolonged periods will result in a ghost image
remaining even when you change the image. Avoid allowing a fixed image to remain on the
screen for prolonged periods.
Option
Smart Share Setting
Sets it if image sticking is never a problem.
Orbiter
Orbiter may help prevent ghost images. However, it is best not to allow
any fixed image to remain on the screen. To avoid a permanent image on
the screen, the screen will move every 2 minutes.
Colour Wash
Removes a ghost image on the screen.
The colour block with the screen moved a little and the white pattern are
alternately displayed. It is difficult to sense the afterimage occurred while
the temporary afterimage is removed and the colour pattern is operating.
White Wash
Removes a ghost image on the screen.
White wash removes permanent images from the screen.
Note: An excessive permanent image may be impossible to clear entirely
with White Wash.
Sets the pointer option of the magic motion remote control.
Option
Speed
Changes the pointer speed.
Shape
Selects the pointer shape.
Size
Changes the pointer size.
Alignment
Align the remote control’s direction with the pointer on your TV screen by
shaking the remote control left and right. Then, the pointer automatically
moves to the center of the screen.
Sets the DivX and DLNA option.
Option
DivX VOD Registration
Registers your TV to play DivX protected videos. (See p.68)
DivX Deregistration
Deactivates your TV. (See p.68)
DMR
Activates or deactivates the DMR (Digital Media Render) connection.
ENGLISH
ENG
Pointer
(Depending on
model)
Normal
116
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
Setting
Description
Data Service
(This menu is enabled only in South
Africa, Malaysia.)
This function allow users to choose between MHEG (Digital Teletext) and Teletext if both exist at
the same time.
If only one of them exists, either MHEG or Teletext is enabled regardless of which option you
selected.
Factory Reset
Resets the TV to factory default and erases all stored programmes.
Customizes the TV settings to suit your preference. The factory reset screen will appear when you
turn on the TV for the first time.
NOTE
yyIn Lock System “On”, if you forget your password, press ‘0’, ‘3’, ‘2’, ‘5’ on the remote
control handset.
Set ID
Adds an ID to the connected devices
Mode Setting
Default selection is “Home Use”. We recommend setting the TV to “Home Use” mode for the best
picture in your home environment.
Option
Home Use
Selects it for the home environment.
Store Demo
Selects it for the retail environment.
Demo Mode
Sets to show special features of the TV.
You can cancel the demo mode by pressing any buttons except the Volume and Mute buttons.
NOTE
ENGLISH
ENG
yyIt is not possible to use Demo Mode in Home Use mode.
yyIn Store Demo, Demo Mode is automatically set to On.
yyOnce Demo Mode is set to Off in Store Demo, Demo Mode
does not run and only the screen is reset.
yyThe screen is reset automatically after 5 minutes in Demo
Mode.
IR Blaster
(Depending on
model)
Adjusts when connecting Wireless media box (sold seperate).
For futher information, refer to the optional "Wireless media box" manual for operating inssturctions.
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
117
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
NETWORK Settings
NETWORK
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to NETWORK and
Move
OK
• Network Setting
: Wired
• Network Status
: Internet is connected
Exit
• Smart TV Setting
• Legal Notice
press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available network settings are described in the following.
Setting
Network Setting
Description
Configure the network settings (See p.46).
Network Status Display the network status (See p.52).
Set the region for which weather forecast is provided and manage the IDs added to the TV.
Setting
Country Setting
Set the country for premium services. Different premium services
are provided depending on the country you set.
Weather Effect
Sets the region for the weather to be displayed on the background
of the premium service.
Select your region.
Premium Version Display the version of the premium service.
Legal Notice
ID Management
Manage the login history of the IDs added to the TV.
Reset
Delete all IDs added on the TV. Please be aware that all your paid applications
may be deleted.
Display the Legal notice.(See p.54).
ENGLISH
ENG
Smart TV Setting
118
CUSTOMIZING SETTINGS
SUPPORT Settings
y Image shown may differ from your TV.
SUPPORT
1 Press Home to access the Home menu.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SETUP and press
OK.
Move
OK
• Software Update
• Picture Test
• Sound Test
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SUPPORT and
• Signal Test
• Product/Service Info.
• Initialization of Premium
press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to the setting or option
you want and press OK.
- To return to the previous level, press BACK.
5 When you are finished, press EXIT.
The available support settings are described in the following.
Setting
Description
ENGLISH
ENG
Software Update
Update the TV with the latest firmware.
Picture Test
Sound Test
Executes picture or built-in melody sound tests.
» If this test has an error, select Yes. You will see the product or service information.
» If this test has no errors, check the connection status of external devices and refer to the
manual of external devices.
Signal Test
Shows the MUX and Service information etc.
NOTE
y This displays the information and signal strength of the tuned *MUX.
y This displays the signal information and service name of the selected MUX.(*MUX:
A higher directory of channels in digital broadcasting (a single MUX contains multiple
channels.))
Product/Service Info.
Shows the product or service information.
Customer Service Center can differ by country.
Initialization of
Premium
Initialize the premium menu if an error occurs while updating the premium menu.
Then, the TV automatically switches off and then back on.
Exit
MAKING CONNECTIONS
119
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Connect various external devices to the TV and switch input modes to select an external device. For more
information on external device’s connection, refer to the manual provided with each device.
Available external devices are: HD receivers, DVD players, VCRs, audio systems, USB storage devices,
PC, gaming devices, and other external devices.
NOTE
If you record a TV programme on a DVD recorder or VCR, make sure to connect the TV
yy
signal input cable to the TV through a DVD recorder or VCR. For more information on
recording, refer to the manual provided with the connected device.
The external device connection may differ from the model.
yy
Connect external devices to the TV regardless of the order of the TV port.
yy
ENGLISH
ENG
120
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Connection Overview
Connect various external devices to the ports on the TV back panel.
1 Find an external device you want to connect to your TV as shown on the following illustration.
2 Check the connection type of the external device.
3 Go to the appropriate illustration and check the connection details.
HD Receiver
DVD
ENGLISH
ENG
Speaker
PC
VCR
USB
HDMI – See p.121, 125
DVI – See p.122, 126
Component – See p.123
Composite – See p.124
RGB – See p.126
Memory storage – See p.129
Memory card reader – See p.129
Digital Optical Audio – See p.128
Gaming device
NOTE
If you connect a gaming device to the TV, use the cable supplied with the gaming device.
yy
Refer to the external equipment's manual for operating instructions.
yy
MAKING CONNECTIONS
This section on MAKING CONNECTIONS
yy
mainly uses diagrams for the 47/55LW95**
models.
Image shown may differ from your TV.
yy
Connecting to a HD receiver,
DVD, or VCR player
121
NOTE
Use the latest High Speed HDMI™ Cable
yy
with CEC (Customer Electronics Control)
function.
High Speed HDMI™ Cables are tested
yy
to carry an HD signal up to 1080p and
higher.
Connect a HD receiver, DVD, or VCR player to the
TV and select an appropriate input mode.
HDMI connection
IN 4
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Transmits the digital video and audio signals from
an external device to the TV. Connect the external
device and the TV with the HDMI cable as shown
in the following illustration.
/DVI
ENGLISH
ENG
IN 3
ELESS
NTROL
IN 2
VIDEO
/DVI
IN 1
IN 1
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
HDMI
AV IN 2
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
or
VIDEO
AV IN 1
LAN
OPTICAL
DIGITA
T L
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
PB
IN2
/DVI IN1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
R
COMPONENT IN
L
2
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
PR
AUDIO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
1
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA IN
HDMI
122
MAKING CONNECTIONS
DVI to HDMI Connection
IN 4
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Transmits the digital video signal from an external
device to the TV. Connect the external device and
the TV with the DVI-HDMI cable as shown in the
following illustration. To transmit an audio signal,
connect an audio cable.
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
IN 2
PR
R
IN 1
AUDIO
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
VIDEO
/DVI
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO / VIDEO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
AUDIO OUT
DVI OUT
ENGLISH
ENG
or
VIDEO
AV IN 1
LAN
OPTICAL
DIGITA
T L
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
PB
IN2
/DVI IN1
AUDIO OUT
DVI OUT
2
R
1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
COMPONENT IN
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
PR
ANTENNA IN
or
/DVI
Transmits the analogue video and audio signals
from an external device to the TV. Connect the
external device and the TV with the component
cable as shown in the following illustration.
IN 4
PB
/DVI
/DVI
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
R
2
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
COMPONENT IN
AUDIO
R
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO / VIDEO
L
1
L/MONO AUDIO R
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO L/MONO
IN 2
VIDEO
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
PR
PR
AV IN 2
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
IN2
/DVI IN1
AV IN 1
/DVI
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
IN 1
Y
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
VIDEO
Y
COMPONENT
IN 1
WIRELESS
CONTROL
AV IN 1
LAN
VIDEO
USB IN 1
Component Connection
ANTENNA IN
H/P
VIDEO
AUDIO
NOTE
/DVI
USB IN 1
VIDEO
AUDIO
IN 4
or
VIDEO
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
PR
/DVI
AV IN 1
IN 2
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
WIRELESS
CONTROL
/DVI
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
VIDEO
AUDIO
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
ENGLISH
ENG
USB IN 2
If cables are installed incorrectly, it could
yy
case the image to display in black and
white or with distorted colour. Check to
ensure the cable are matched with the
corresponding colour connection.
IN 1
LAN
123
USB IN 2
MAKING CONNECTIONS
MAKING CONNECTIONS
or
USB IN 2
PB
VIDEO
/DVI
IN 4
/DVI
IN 3
/DVI
IN 2
/DVI
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
VIDEO L (MONO) AUDIO R
H/P
R AUDIO L/MONO
2
COMPONENT IN
AUDIO
R
1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
/DVI
L(MONO) R AUDIO
/DVI
NOTE
AV IN 2
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
IN 1
R
AUDIO / VIDEO
L
IN 1
USB IN 2
USB IN 1
R
AUDIO
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
VIDEO
L/MONO AUDIO R
AUDIO
VIDEO
PR
AV IN 2
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
/DVI IN1
IN 2
VIDEO
L
PB
VIDEO
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
or
IN2
AV IN 1
PR
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
Y
ENGLISH
ENG
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
LAN
AV IN 1
/DVI
IN 3
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
COMPONENT
IN 1
WIRELESS
CONTROL
PB
/DVI
RGB IN (PC)
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
L(MONO) R AUDIO
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
PR
COMPONENT
IN 1
VIDEO
Y
VIDEO
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
USB IN 1
Transmits the analogue video and audio signals
from an external device to the TV. Connect the
external device and the TV with the composite
cable as shown in the following illustration.
LAN
AV IN 1
LAN
VIDEO
Composite Connection
IN 4
124
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
If you have a mono VCR, connect the audio
yy
cable from the VCR to the AUDIO L/MONO
jack of the TV.
ANTENNA IN
MAKING CONNECTIONS
125
Connecting to a PC
NOTE
yy
It is recommended to use the TV set with the
HDMI connection for the best image quality.
HDMI Connection
/DVI
IN 4
/DVI
HDD IN
USB IN 1
USB Apps
USB IN 2
Transmits the digital video and audio signals from
your PC to the TV. Connect the PC and the TV
with the HDMI cable as shown in the following
illustrations.
IN 3
ELESS
NTROL
IN 2
VIDEO
/DVI
IN 1
/DVI
IN 1
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
or
VIDEO
AV IN 1
LAN
OPTICAL
DIGITA
T L
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
P
IN2
B
/DVI IN1
R
2
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
COMPONENT IN
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
PR
1
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
ANTENNA IN
HDMI
ENGLISH
ENG
L/MONO AUDIO R
HDMI
AV IN 2
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
MAKING CONNECTIONS
USB IN 2
126
Transmits the digital video signal from your PC to
the TV. Connect the PC and the TV with the DVI HDMI cable as shown in the following illustration.
To transmit an audio signal, connect an audio
cable.
Transmits the analogue video signal from an
external device to the TV. Connect the external
device and the TV with the RGB cable as shown
in the following illustration. To transmit an audio
signal, connect an optional audio cable.
IN 4
/DVI
USB IN 1
RGB Connection
WIRELESS
CONTROL
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
Y
IN 2
VIDEO
/DVI
AV IN 1
PR
R
IN 1
AUDIO
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
HDD IN
USB IN 1
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
USB Apps
USB IN 2
DVI to HDMI Connection
/DVI
AV IN 2
IN 4
LAN
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
AUDIO / VIDEO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
IN 2
PR
R
IN 1
AUDIO
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
VIDEO
/DVI
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO / VIDEO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
RGB OUT (PC) AUDIO OUT
or
AUDIO OUT
VIDEO
ENGLISH
ENG
AV IN 1
LAN
DVI OUT
OPTICAL
DIGITA
T L
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
PB
VIDEO
PB
DVI OUT
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
2
R
COMPONENT IN
AUDIO
AUDIO OUT
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
COMPONENT IN
ANTENNA IN
RGB OUT (PC) AUDIO OUT
L
1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
R
/DVI IN1
PR
RGB IN (PC)
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
2
IN2
1
VIDEO
Y
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
AV IN 1
LAN
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
/DVI IN1
PR
or
OPTICAL
DIGITA
T L
AUDIO OUT
IN2
ANTENNA IN
MAKING CONNECTIONS
127
NOTE
ENGLISH
ENG
There may be interference relating to
yy
resolution, vertical pattern, contrast or
brightness in PC mode. Change the PC
mode to another resolution or change the
refresh rate to another rate or adjust the
brightness and contrast on the menu until the
picture is clear. If the refresh rate of the PC
graphic card can not be changed, change the
PC graphic card or consult the manufacturer
of the PC graphic card.
The synchronization input waveform for
yy
Horizontal and Vertical frequencies are
separate.
We recommend using 1920x1080, 60 Hz for
yy
the PC mode, this should provide the best
picture quality.
Connect the signal cable from the monitor
yy
output port of the PC to the RGB (PC) port
of the TV or the signal cable from the HDMI
output port of the PC to the HDMI IN (or
HDMI/DVI IN) port on the TV.
Connect the audio cable from the PC to the
yy
Audio input on the TV. (Audio cables are not
included with the TV).
If using a sound card, adjust PC sound as
yy
required.
If the graphic card on the PC does not output
yy
analogue and digital RGB simultaneously,
connect only one of either RGB or HDMI IN
(or HDMI/DVI IN) to display the PC output on
the TV.
DOS mode may not work depending on the
yy
video card if you use an HDMI to DVI cable.
If you use too long an RGB-PC cable, there
yy
may be interference on the screen. We
recommend using under 5m of cable. This
provides the best picture quality.
128
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Connecting to an Audio
System
CAUTION
yy
Do not look into the optical output port.
Looking at the laser beam may damage your
vision.
Use an external audio system instead of the
built-in speaker.
NOTE
/DVI
USB IN 1
USB IN 2
If you use an external audio device instead
yy
of the built-in speaker, set the TV speaker
feature to off (See p.108).
IN 4
Digital Optical Audio Connection
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
Transmits the digital audio signal from the TV to an
external device. Connect the external device and
the TV with the optical audio cable as shown in the
following illustration.
IN 2
PR
R
IN 1
AUDIO
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
VIDEO
/DVI
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
OPTICAL DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
AUDIO / VIDEO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
ENGLISH
ENG
OPTICAL AUDIO IN
or
VIDEO
AV IN 1
LAN
OPTICAL
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
(RGB/DVI)
VIDEO
Y
PB
IN2
/DVI IN1
COMPONENT IN
2
R
1
RS-232C IN
(CONTROL & SERVICE)
OPTICAL AUDIO IN
L
AUDIO
RGB IN (PC)
R AUDIO
AUDIO L/MONO
PR
ANTENNA IN
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Connecting to Headphone
Connection
Connecting to a USB
Connect a USB storage device such as a USB
flash memory, external hard drive or a USB
memory card reader to the TV and access the
Smart Share menu to use various multimedia files.
See “Connecting USB storage devices” on See p.61
and see “Browsing files”.
IN 4
/DVI
USB IN 1
USB IN 2
(Depending on model)
Listen to the sound through a headphone.
129
USB Apps
USB IN 2
IN 3
WIRELESS
CONTROL
/DVI
AV IN 1
or
/DVI
IN 1
/DVI
L/MONO AUDIO R
HDD IN
USB IN 1
IN 2
VIDEO
H/P
Y
/DVI
COMPONENT
IN 1
WIRELESS
CONTROL
PB
VIDEO
IN 3
AUDIO / Y PB PR
AV IN 1
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
AUDIO
ENGLISH
ENG
VIDEO
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
PR
/DVI
COMPONENT IN 2
IN 2
AUDIO / VIDEO
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
IN 4
AV IN 2
or
AV IN 2
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
NOTE
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGITAL
DIGIT
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO menu items are disabled when
yy
connecting a headphone.
When changing AV MODE with a headphone
yy
connected, the change is applied to video but
not to audio.
Optical Digital Audio Out is not available
yy
when connecting a headphone.
Headphone impedance: 16 Ω
yy
Max audio output of headphone: 10 mW to
yy
15 mW
Headphone jack size: 0.35 cm
yy
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
or
USB IN 1/HDD IN USB IN 2/USB Apps
LAN
USB IN 1/HDD IN USB IN 2/USB Apps
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGIT
DIGITAL
AUDIO OUT
/DVI
IN 1(ARC)
IN
DVI)
/DVI
ONENT
1
130
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Connecting the Wireless
Media Box
SIMPLINK Connection
(Except for 32/37/42/47/55LV37**,
50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**)
LG TVs with a Wireless Control port support the
LG Wireless Media Box, which is sold separately.
When you connect the Wireless Ready Dongle
(included with the Wireless Media Box) to the
TV, external devices can be connected to the LG
Wireless Media Box and video and audio will be
sent to the TV wirelessly.
Refer to the Wireless Media Box manual for
operating instructions.
USB Apps
USB IN 2
HDD IN
USB IN 1
/DVI
IN 4
/DVI
IN 3
/DVI
IN 2
VIDEO
PR
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
/DVI
PB
VIDEO
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
IN 1
Y
ENGLISH
ENG
AV IN 1
AV IN 2
LAN
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGITAL
DIGIT
AUDIO OUT
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
WIRELESS
CONTROL
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
Connect one end of the HDMI cable to the HDMI/
DVI IN or HDMI IN terminal on the rear of the TV
and the other end to the SIMPLINK device.
NOTE
COMPONENT
IN 1
WIRELESS
CONTROL
Play and control the AV device connected with
the HDMI cable through HDMI-CEC. This TV may
work with the devices that support HDMI-CEC, but
only devices with the
logo are fully
supported.
H/P
HDMI OUT
LG Wireless Media Box
NOTE
When using the external device connected
yy
to the Wireless Media Box, some functions
of the TV menu may not work.
If the connected device does not support
yy
HDMI-CEC, the SIMPLINK feature is
unavailable.
To operate SIMPLINK, an High Speed HDMI
yy
Cable with *CEC function should be used.
(*CEC: Consumer Electronics Control).
SIMPLINK may not work properly if you a
yy
third-party device that has an HDMI-CEC
function.
In wireless external output, SIMPLINK
yy
function is not supported.
MAKING CONNECTIONS
Activating and Using the SIMPLINK menus
1 Press INPUT to access the input sources.
2 Press Red button to access the SIMPLINK
menus.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to select to On.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to one of
the devices and press OK.
►
On
◄
Watch TV
◀ DISC 1
▶
1
2
◀ VCR 1
▶
3
HDD/DVD-R
HD HT
HDD Recorder
◀ Speaker
TV Speaker
5
- A check mark appears in front of the selected
device.
- Available devices display in a bright colour.
- Unavailable devices display in grey.
5 Control the selected AV device.
- Direct Play: After connecting AV devices to
the TV, you can directly control the devices
and play media without additional settings.
- Select AV device: Enables you to select one
of the AV devices connected to the TV.
- Disc playback: Control connected AV devices by pressing the Navigation buttons, OK,
, , , and .
- Power off all devices: When you power off
the TV, all connected devices are turned off.
- Switch audio-out: Offers an easy way to
switch audio-out.
- Sync Power on: When the equipment with
SIMPLINK function connected HDMI terminal
starts to play, The TV will automatically turn
on.
Exit
NOTE
No.
1
2
3
4
5
Description
Displays the previously viewed TV channel.
Plays discs. When multiple discs are available, the title of the disc appears at the bottom of the screen.
Controls the connected VCR.
HDD recordings playback: Controls the
recording stored in HDD.
Audio out to home theatre speaker or Audio
out to TV: Changes the audio output between
Home theatre speaker and TV speaker.
If you change the input source by pressing
yy
INPUT, the progressing function of the
SIMPLINK device will stop.
If you select a device that has the home theyy
atre feature, the sound output automatically
switches to the home theatre speaker and
the TV speaker turns off.
If a connected SIMPLINK home theatre
yy
system does not play the audio from the TV,
connect the DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal
on the rear of the TV to the DIGITAL AUDIO
IN terminal on the back of the SIMPLINK
device with an optical cable.
ENGLISH
ENG
INPUT
4
▶
131
132
TELETEXT
TELETEXT
Top Text
yy
This feature is not available in all countries.
Teletext is a free service broadcast by most TV
stations which gives up-to-the-minute information
on news, weather, television programmes, share
prices and many other topics.
Block / Group / Page Selection
The teletext decoder of this TV can support the
SIMPLE, TOP and FASTEXT systems. SIMPLE
(standard teletext) consists of a number of pages
which are selected by directly entering the corresponding page number. TOP and FASTEXT are
more modern methods allowing quick and easy
selection of teletext information.
Switch On/Off
ENGLISH
ENG
Press the TEXT button to switch to teletext. The
initial page or last page viewed appears on the
screen.
Two page numbers, TV station name, date and
time are displayed on the screen headline. The
first page number indicates your selection, while
the second shows the current page displayed.
Press the TEXT button to switch off teletext. The
previous mode reappears.
Simple Text
Page selection
1 Enter the desired page number as a three
digit number with the NUMBER buttons. If
during selection you press a wrong number,
you must complete the three digit number and
then re-enter the correct page number.
2 The P
button can be used to select the
preceding or following page.
The user guide displays four fields-red, green,
yellow and blue at the bottom of the screen. The
yellow field denotes the next group and the blue
field indicates the next block.
1 With the Blue button you can progress from
block to block.
2 Use the Yellow button to proceed to the next
group with automatic overflow to the next
block.
3 With the Green button you can proceed to the
next existing page with automatic overflow to
the next group.
4 Alternatively, the P
button can be used. The
red button returns to the previous selection.
Alternatively the P button can be used.
Direct Page Selection
s with SIMPLE teletext mode, you can select a
A
page by entering it as a three digit number using
the NUMBER buttons in TOP mode.
TELETEXT
Fastext
133
ꔾ Time
The teletext pages are colour coded along the bottom of the screen and are selected by pressing the
corresponding coloured button.
Page selection
1 Press the T.OPT button and then use the Navigation button to select ꔻ menu. Display the
index page.
2 You can select the pages which are colour
coded along the bottom line with corresponding
coloured buttons.
3 AS with SIMPLE teletext mode, you can select
a page by entering its three digit page number
with the NUMBER buttons in FASTEXT mode.
4 The P
button can be used to select the
preceding or following page.
Press the T. OPT button and then use the Navigation button to select the Text Option menu.
ꕀ Hold
Stops the automatic page change which will
occur if a teletext page consists of 2 or more
sub pages. The number of sub pages and the
sub page displayed is, usually, shown on the
screen below the time. When this menu is
selected the stop symbol is displayed at the top
left-hand corner of the screen and the automatic page change is inactive.
ꔽ Reveal
Select this menu to display concealed information, such as solutions to riddles or puzzles.
ꔼ Update
Text Option
Index
Time
Hold
Reveal
Update
Close
ꔻ Index
Select the each index page.
Displays the TV picture on the screen while
waiting for a new teletext page. The display
will appear at the top left hand corner of the
screen. When the updated page is available
then display will change to the page number.
Select this menu again to view the updated
teletext page.
ENGLISH
ENG
Special Teletext Function
When viewing a TV programme, select this
menu to display the time at the top right hand
corner of the screen.
In the teletext mode, press this button to select
a sub page number. The sub page number is
displayed at the bottom of the screen. To hold
or change the sub page, press the Red button,
Green button, < > or NUMBER buttons.
134
MAINTENANCE
MAINTENANCE
Update and clean your TV regularly to keep the
best performance and to extend the product
lifespan.
Updating the TV firmware
Download and install the latest firmware by connecting to the firmware update server or broadcasting OTA service to enhance or change the
product function, or add new features.
The firmware update may not work properly depending on the Internet environment or DTV signal
strength. If so, you may obtain the latest firmware
update from the authorized LG Electronics service
center.
To check the current firmware version or update
the firmware,
NOTE
yy
While updating the firmware, do not disconnect the LAN cable, turn the TV off, or
unplug the power cord.
yy
If you change the channel during the
firmware update via OTA, the update stops.
The process resumes when you go back to
the original programme. The update continues even when the power is switched off
using the remote control. In this case, it is
normal that the colour of the power indicator
may change and a dim light may be displayed on the screen. The system operates
normally once the update is complete.
yy
Premium service is disabled while the software is being updated through NSU.
yy
You can check the software update status in
the Software Update menu or from the update information displayed under the channel
banner.
ENGLISH
ENG
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to SUPPORT and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Software Update and press OK.
The current firmware version displays.
5 Select Check Update Version to check a new
firmware version manually.
Software Update ◀
On
▶
• Current Version
01.00.09
Check Update Version
Close
If selecting Software Update - On, the TV
finds a new firmware through the NSU* and
the update pop-up window will appear on the
screen.
* OTA(Over The Air): If watching the digital
broadcasting system, the TV is transmitted
new firmware thorugh DTV signal.
6 When the update is complete, the TV will automatically restart in 5 seconds.
You may need to reset some SETUP, PICTURE, or AUDIO menus.
NOTE
yy
You cannot downgrade back to an older
firmware version.
yy
The period of time for the firmware update
may be different depending on the firmware
size, network condition or DTV signal
strength.
yy
If the firmware update download fails when
using wireless, temporarily connect a cable
directly to your router. If it still does not
download, contact customer service.
MAINTENANCE
Cleaning Your TV
CAUTION
yy
Make sure to turn the power off and disconnect the power cord and all other cables first.
yy
When the TV is left unattended and unused
for a long time, disconnect the power cord
from the wall outlet to prevent possible damage from lightning or power surges.
Screen and frame
To remove dust or light dirt, wipe the surface with a
dry, clean, and soft cloth.
To remove major dirt, wipe the surface with a soft
cloth dampened in clean water or a diluted mild
detergent. Then wipe immediately with a dry cloth.
CAUTION
Cabinet and stand
To remove dust or light dirt, wipe the cabinet with a
dry, clean, and soft cloth.
To remove major dirt, wipe the cabinet with a soft
cloth dampened in a clean water or water containing a small amount of mild detergent. Then wipe
immediately with a dry cloth.
CAUTION
yy
Do not spray liquid onto the surface. If water
enters the TV, it may result in fire, electric
shock, or malfunction.
yy
Do not use any chemicals as this may deteriorate the surface.
Power cord
Remove the accumulated dust or dirt on the power
cord regularly.
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Do not push, rub, or hit the surface with
your fingernail or a sharp object, as this may
result in scratches on the screen and image
distortions.
yy
Do not use any chemicals, such as waxes,
benzene, alcohol, thinners, insecticides, air
fresheners, lubricants, as these may damage
the screen’s finish and cause discolourations.
135
136
MAINTENANCE
Preventing “Image burn” or “Burn-in” on your TV screen
yy
If a fixed image displays on the TV screen for a long period of time, it will be imprinted and become a permanent disfigurement on the screen. This is “image burn” or “burn-in” and not covered by the warranty.
yy
If the aspect ratio of the TV is set to 4:3 for a long period of time, image burn may occur on the letterboxed area of the screen.
yy
Avoid displaying a fixed image on the TV screen for a long period of time (2 or more hours for LCD, 1 or
more hours for the Plasma TV) to prevent image burn.
ENGLISH
ENG
TROUBLESHOOTING
137
TROUBLESHOOTING
General
Problem
Resolution
Cannot control the TV with the
remote control.
yyCheck the remote control sensor on the product and try again.
yyCheck if there is any obstacle between the product and the remote control.
yyCheck if the batteries are still working and properly installed ( to ,
to ).
yyCheck if the appropriate input mode such as TV or VCR is set for using the
remote control.
No image display and no sound is
produced.
yyCheck if the product is turned on.
yyCheck if the power cord is connected to a wall outlet.
yyCheck if there is a problem in the wall outlet by connecting other products.
Image appears slowly when the TV
turns on.
yyThe image is muted during the product stat up process. This is normal. If the
image does not appear in a few minutes, unplug the TV for 30 seconds and
try again. If the image still does not appear, contact the authorized service
centre in your local area.
Cannot connect external devices.
yyRefer to the “Connection overview” and connect an external device.
The TV turns off suddenly.
yyCheck the power control settings. The power supply may be interrupted.
yyCheck if the Auto sleep feature is activated in the Time settings.
Refer to the “Sleep Timer”.
yyIf there is no signal while the TV is on, the TV will turn off automatically after
15 minutes of inactivity.
ENGLISH
ENG
Audio
Problem
No sound is produced while images
are displaying.
Resolution
yyPress
+ or - button.
yyCheck if the sound is muted by pressing MUTE.
yyScroll to other channels. There may a problem with the broadcast.
yyCheck if the audio cables are connected properly.
yyCheck if the TV Speaker feature is activated in the menu option.
No output from one of the speakers
yyAdjust Balance in the menu option.
Unusual sound from inside the TV
is produced.
yyA change in ambient humidity or temperature may result in an unusual noise
when the product turns on or off. There is no problem with your product.
138
TROUBLESHOOTING
Video
Problem
Resolution
ENGLISH
ENG
An image displays in black and
white or the colour quality is poor.
yyAdjust the colour setting in the menu option.
yyKeep a sufficient distance between this product and other electronic products.
yyScroll to other channels. There may a problem with the broadcast.
Horizontal or vertical bars appears
or images blur
yyCheck if there is local interference such as an electrical appliance or power
tool.
Lines or streaks appear on images
yyCheck the antenna or aim the antenna to the correct direction.
Afterimages (ghosts) appear when
the product turns off
yyPixels may have been damaged from a fixed image displayed for a long time
(image burn). Use a screen saver to prevent the pixel damage on the screen.
The power is on but the screen appears extremely dark.
yyAdjust the brightness and contrast in the menu option.
“No Signal” appears on the screen.
yyCheck if the signal cable is connected between the TV and products properly.
yyCheck the selected input source by pressing INPUT.
Black spots appear on the screen.
yySeveral pixels in red, green, white, or black may appear on the screen that
can attribute to the characteristics of the LCD panel.
This is normal.
The display offset is wrong.
yyAdjust the position setting in the menu option.
yyCheck if the video card resolution and frequency are supported by the product. If the frequency is out of range, set to the recommended resolution using
the display settings on the external device.
Thin lines appear in the background
of the screen.
yyCheck the video cable connections.
Horizontal noises appear or characters blur.
yyAdjust the Phase setting in the menu option.
Refer to the “SCREEN”.
The reception on some channels
is poor
yyScroll to other channels. There may a problem with the broadcast.
yyThe station signal may be weak. Aim the antenna to the correct direction.
yyCheck if there is local interference such as an electrical appliance or power
tool.
SPECIFICATIONS
139
SPECIFICATIONS
32LV37**
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
37LV37**
32LV3710-TB
32LV3730-TD
37LV3730-TD
32LV370S-TC
37LV371Y-TB
With stand
32LV371Y-TB
764 mm x 545 mm x 240 mm
888 mm x 614 mm x 240 mm
Without stand
764 mm x 484 mm x 35.4 mm
888 mm x 553 mm x 35.4 mm
With stand
11.4 kg
13.5 kg
Without stand
9.6 kg
11.7 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
42LV37**
42LV3710-TB
MODELS
47LV37**
47LV3710-TB
42LV3730-TD
47LV3730-TD
42LV370S-TC
47LV370S-TC
42LV371Y-TB
Weight
998 mm x 684 mm x 256 mm
1108 mm x 746 mm x 256 mm
Without stand
998 mm x 615 mm x 30.4 mm
1108 mm x 677 mm x 30.4 mm
With stand
15.5 kg
20.9 kg
Without stand
13.3 kg
18.7 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
55LV37**
55LV3730-TD
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
With stand
1286 mm x 847 mm x 338 mm
Without stand
1286 mm x 778 mm x 30.4 mm
With stand
25.5 kg
Without stand
21.4 kg
Power requirement
55LV371Y-TB
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
ENGLISH
ENG
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
47LV371Y-TB
With stand
140
SPECIFICATIONS
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
32LV55**
37LV55**
32LV5500-TA
37LV5500-TA
With stand
32LV550Y-TA
776 mm x 549 mm x 240 mm
37LV550Y-TA
896 mm x 617 mm x 240 mm
Without stand
776 mm x 485 mm x 34.9 mm
896 mm x 553 mm x 34.9 mm
With stand
10.8 kg
12.6 kg
Without stand
8.8 kg
10.8 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
MODELS
42LV55**
47LV55**
42LV5500-TA
47LV5500-TA
42LV550Y-TA
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
47LV550Y-TA
With stand
1012 mm x 683 mm x 256 mm
1121 mm x 746 mm x 256 mm
Without stand
1012 mm x 617 mm x 29.9 mm
1121 mm x 678 mm x 29.9 mm
With stand
15.5 kg
20.7 kg
Without stand
13.2 kg
18.4 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
ENGLISH
ENG
55LV55**
55LV5500-TA
MODELS
55LV550Y-TA
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
With stand
1298 mm x 849 mm x 338 mm
Without stand
1298 mm x 778 mm x 29.9 mm
With stand
25.8 kg
Without stand
21.7 kg
Power requirement
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
SPECIFICATIONS
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
42LW57**
47LW57**
42LW5700-TA
47LW5700-TA
With stand
42LW570Y-TA
999 mm x 681 mm x 255 mm
47LW570Y-TA
1109 mm x 744 mm x 255 mm
Without stand
999 mm x 623 mm x 30.9 mm
1109 mm x 684 mm x 30.9 mm
With stand
15.7 kg
20.2 kg
Without stand
13.4 kg
17.9 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
55LW57**
55LW5700-TA
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
With stand
1286 mm x 848 mm x 338 mm
Without stand
1286 mm x 784 mm x 30.9 mm
With stand
26.2 kg
Without stand
22.1 kg
Power requirement
55LW570Y-TA
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
MODELS
47LW65**
42LW6500-TA
47LW6500-TA
42LW6510-TB
47LW6510-TB
42LW651Y-TB
Weight
1009 mm x 686 mm x 255 mm
1119 mm x 749 mm x 255 mm
Without stand
1009 mm x 622 mm x 29.9 mm
1119 mm x 684 mm x 29.9 mm
With stand
16.2 kg
21.0 kg
Without stand
13.4 kg
18.2 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
55LW65**
55LW6500-TA
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
47LW651Y-TB
With stand
65LW65**
65LW6500-TA
55LW6510-TB
65LW651Y-TB
With stand
55LW651Y-TB
1297 mm x 851 mm x 341 mm
1555 mm x 1012 mm x 341 mm
Without stand
1297 mm x 785 mm x 29.9 mm
1555 mm x 940 mm x 38.1 mm
With stand
27.0 kg
49.0 kg
Without stand
22.0 kg
42.0 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
ENGLISH
ENG
42LW65**
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
141
142
SPECIFICATIONS
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
Without stand
1114 mm x 680 mm x 31.1 mm
1291 mm x 780 mm x 31.1 mm
With stand
23.7 kg
33.4 kg
Without stand
20.9 kg
28.2 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
47LW9500-TA
55LW9500-TA
1265 mm x 831 mm x 285 mm
Without stand
1095 mm x 665 mm x 27.5 mm
1265 mm x 760 mm x 27.5 mm
With stand
22.5 kg
29 kg
Without stand
18.2 kg
23.8 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
ENGLISH
ENG
47LW98**
55LW98**
47LW9800-TA
55LW9800-TA
47LW980Y-TA
55LW980Y-TA
With stand
1095 mm x 735 mm x 235 mm
1265 mm x 831 mm x 285 mm
Without stand
1095 mm x 665 mm x 27.9 mm
1265 mm x 760 mm x 27.9 mm
With stand
22.5 kg
29 kg
Without stand
18.2 kg
23.8 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
MODELS
Weight
55LW95**
1095 mm x 735 mm x 235 mm
Power requirement
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
47LW95**
With stand
MODELS
Weight
55LW7700-TA
1291 mm x 860 mm x 347 mm
Power requirement
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
47LW7700-TA
1114 mm x 747 mm x 263 mm
MODELS
Weight
55LW77**
With stand
Power requirement
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
47LW77**
47LZ96**
55LZ96**
47LZ9600-TA
55LZ9600-TA
With stand
1069 mm x 722 mm x 307 mm
1242 mm x 819 mm x 307 mm
Without stand
1069 mm x 627 mm x 19.8 mm
1242 mm x 725 mm x 20.5 mm
With stand
20.2 kg
24.8 kg
Without stand
11.5 kg
16.1 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
Power requirement
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
SPECIFICATIONS
MODELS
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
Weight
Without stand
1175.2 x 720.6 x 49.6 mm
1393.4 mm x 843.8 mm x 49.6 mm
With stand
32.5 kg
46.3 kg
Without stand
28.9 kg
40.3 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
60PZ57**
50PZ570-TB
60PZ570-TB
1172.3 mm X 770.9 mm X 289.8 mm
1391.1 mm X 905.2 mm X 334.7 mm
Without stand
1172.3 mm X 712.2 mm X 52.5 mm
1391.1 mm X 835.5 mm X 52.5 mm
With stand
29.8 kg
42.6 kg
Without stand
27.5 kg
38.5 kg
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
50PZ65**
50PZ650-TD
1168.7 mm X 768.3 mm X 289.8 mm
Without stand
1168.7 mm X 712.2 mm X 52.5 mm
With stand
29.8 kg
Without stand
27.5 kg
Operating Temperature
Operating Humidity
Storage Temperature
Storage Humidity
AC 100-240 V~ 50 / 60 Hz
0 °C to 40 °C
Less than 80 %
-20 °C to 60 °C
Less than 85 %
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
For the power supply and power consumption, refer to the label attached to the product.
ENGLISH
ENG
With stand
Power requirement
Environment
condition
50PZ57**
With stand
MODELS
Weight
60PZ950-TA
1393.4 mm x 916.4 mm x 364.4 mm
Power requirement
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
50PZ950-TA
1175.2 x 787.6 x 317.2 mm
MODELS
Weight
60PZ95**
With stand
Power requirement
Dimensions
(W x H x D)
50PZ95**
143
144
SPECIFICATIONS
New Zealand, Singapore
Television System
Programme Coverage
Australia
Television System
Programme Coverage
Indonesia, Israel
Television System
Programme Coverage
South Africa
Television System
Programme Coverage
ENGLISH
ENG
Vietnam, Malaysia
Television System
Programme Coverage
Iran
Television System
Programme Coverage
Analogue model
Television System
Programme Coverage
External Antenna
Impedance
Digital TV
Analogue TV
DVB-T
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I
UHF 21 to 69
DVB-T
VHF 06 to 12,
UHF 27 to 69
DVB-T
UHF 21 to 69
DVB-T
VHF 4 to 11, 13
UHF 21 to 68
DVB-T
VHF 6 to 12,
UHF 21 to 69
DVB-T
VHF 5 to 12,
UHF 21 to 69
-
-
75 Ω
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
PAL B/B
B/B : VHF/UHF 0 to 75, CATV : 2 to 44
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I, NTSC-M
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
M : VHF/UHF 2 to 78, CATV 01 to 71
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I, NTSC-M
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
M : VHF/UHF 2 to 78, CATV 01 to 71
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I, NTSC-M
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
M : VHF/UHF 2 to 78, CATV 01 to 71
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I, NTSC-M
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
M : VHF/UHF 2 to 78, CATV 01 to 71
PAL/SECAM-B/G/D/K, PAL-I, NTSC-M
BG : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
I : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
DK : VHF/UHF 1 to 69, CATV 01 to 47
M : VHF/UHF 2 to 78, CATV 01 to 71
75 Ω
Product specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice due to upgrade of product
functions.
For the power supply and power consumption, refer to the label attached to the product.
SPECIFICATIONS
RGB-PC, HDMI/DVI-PC supported mode
Resolution
720x400
640x480
800x600
1024x768
1360x768
1280x1024
(HDMI-PC)
1920x1080
(RGB-PC)
1920x1080
(HDMI-PC)
Horizontal
Frequency (kHz)
Vertical
Frequency (Hz)
31.468
31.469
37.879
48.363
47.72
70.08
59.94
60.31
60.00
59.80
63.981
60.02
66.587
59.93
67.5
60.00
Resolution
720x480
720x576
1280x720
1920x1080
Horizontal
Frequency (kHz)
Vertical
Frequency (Hz)
31.469
31.5
31.25
37.5
44.96
45
33.72
33.75
28.125
26.97
27
33.716
33.75
56.25
67.43
67.5
59.94
60
50
50
59.94
60
59.94
60
50
23.97
24
29.976
30.00
50
59.94
60
Component port connecting information
Component ports on the
TV
Video output ports
on DVD player
Y
PB
PR
Y
PB
PR
Y
B-Y
R-Y
Y
Cb
Cr
Y
Pb
Pr
Signal
Component
480i/576i
480p/576p
720p/1080i
1080p
O
O
O
O (50 Hz / 60 Hz only)
ENGLISH
ENG
HDMI/DVI-DTV supported mode
145
146
SPECIFICATIONS
DivX supported mode
File Exten- Audio/
sions
Video
.asf
.wmv
Video
Audio
Codec
Profile/Level Support
VC-1 Advanced Profile
Advanced Profile@Level 3
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
VC-1 Simple and Main
Profiles
Simple Profile@Medium Level (e.g.
CIF, QVGA)
Main Profile@High Level (e.g.
1080p30)
Explanation
Only streams compliant to
SMPTE 421M VC-1 standard are supported.
WMA Standard
WMA 9 Professional
DivX3.11
Video
.divx
.avi
Advanced Simple Profile
(e.g. 720p/1080i)
XViD
H.264 / AVC
Audio
ENGLISH
ENG
.mp4
.m4v
.mov
DivX4
DivX5
DivX6
Main Profile@ Level 4.1
High Profile@ Level 4.1
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
MPEG-1 Layer I, II
MPEG-1 Layer III (MP3)
Dolby Digital
H.264 / AVC
Main Profile@ Level 4.1
High Profile@ Level 4.1
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
MPEG-4 Part 2
Advanced Simple Profile (e.g.
720p/1080i)
Audio
AAC
AAC-LC and HE-AAC
Video
H.264 / AVC
Main Profile@ Level 4.1
High Profile@ Level 4.1
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
HE-AAC
HE-AAC-LC and HE-AAC
Video
.mkv
Audio
Audio
Global motion compensation or quarterpel motion
estimation does not supported. Streams using this
syntax are not supported.
Most of the MKV content
available is encoded by the
open source x264 codec.
Dolby Digital
H.264 / AVC
Main Profile@ Level 4.1
High Profile@ Level 4.1
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
MPEG-2
Main Profile@High Level
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60)
VC-1
Simple Profile@Medium Level
(e.g. CIF, QVGA)
Main Profile@High Level
(e.g. 1080p30)
Advanced Profile@Level3
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60, 1080p30)
Video
.ts
.trp
.tp
Global motion compensation or quarterpel motion
estimation does not supported. Streams using this
syntax are not supported.
MPEG-1 Layer I, II
MPEG-1 Layer III (MP3)
Dolby Digital
Dolby Digital Plus
AAC
Only streams compliant to
SMPTE 421M VC-1 standard are supported.
AAC-LC and HE-AAC
MPEG-1
Video
.vob
.mpg
MPEG-2
Audio
Dolby Digital
MPEG-1 Layer I, II
DVD-LPCM
Video
MPEG-1
Audio
MPEG-1 Layer I, II
Main Profile@High Level
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60)
Main Profile@High Level
(e.g. 720p60, 1080i60)
Only streams compliant
configured properly for TS,
PS or ES
SPECIFICATIONS
147
3D supported mode
Only LED LCD TV
Input
Signal
720p
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency (kHz)
Vertical
Frequency (Hz)
Playable 3D video format
45
60
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
89.9/90
59.94/60
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
50
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
1280x720
37.5
75
1080i
60
28.125
50
67.50
60
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
Checker Board,
Single Frame Sequential
56.250
50
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
Checker Board,
Single Frame Sequential
27
24
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
Checker Board,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
53.95/54
23.98/24
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
67.50
30
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
33.75
30
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
Checker Board
1920X1080
HDMI
1080p
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
33.75
1920X1080
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
HDMI 3D Side by Side (Half)
1080p
1920X1080
66.587
59.934
Top & Bottom, Side by Side
USB
1080p
1920X1080
33.75
30
Top & Bottom, Side by Side,
Checker Board, MPO(Photo)
DLNA
1080p
1920X1080
33.75
30
Top & Bottom, Side by Side
Checker Board
DTV
Signal
Playable 3D video format
720p, 1080i
Top & Bottom, Side by Side
yy
Media contents and a player need to support HDMI 3D Frame Packing, HDMI 3D Side by Side, HDMI
3D Top & Bottom to play in 3D.
yy
Video, which is input as HDMI 3D Frame Packing, HDMI 3D Side by Side, HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
format, is switched into the 3D screen automatically.
ENGLISH
ENG
RGB
148
SPECIFICATIONS
Only Plasma TV
Input
Signal
720p
Resolution
Horizontal
Frequency (kHz)
Vertical
Frequency (Hz)
Playable 3D video format
45
60
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
90
60
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
50
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
1280x720
37.5
75
1080i
1920X1080
HDMI
1080p
33.75
60
28.125
50
67.50
60
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board,
Single Frame Sequential
56.250
50
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board,
Single Frame Sequential
27
24
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board,
HDMI 3D Top & Bottom
54
24
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
33.75
30
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board
66.587
59.934
Side by Side, Top & Bottom
37.5
50
1920X1080
ENGLISH
ENG
RGB
HDMI 3D Frame Packing
1080p
1920X1080
720p
1280X720
Component
45
60
50
/60
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
HDMI 3D Side by Side(Half)
Side by Side, Top & Bottom
1080i
1920X1080
28.125
/ 33.75
USB
1080p
1920X1080
33.75
30
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board, MPO(Photo)
DLNA
1080p
1920X1080
33.75
30
Side by Side, Top & Bottom,
Checker Board
Signal
DTV
720p, 1080i
Playable 3D video format
Side by Side, Top & Bottom
yy
Media contents and a player need to support HDMI 3D Frame Packing, HDMI 3D Side by Side, HDMI
3D Top & Bottom to play in 3D.
yy
Video, which is input as HDMI 3D Frame Packing format, is switched into the 3D screen automatically.
yy
2D → 3D mode is available to watch for all signals.
SPECIFICATIONS
149
Wireless LAN for Broadband/DLNA Adaptor module(WN8522D1) specification
This device only works with compatible 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**.
Standard
IEEE802.11a/b/g/n
2402 to 2483 MHz
Frequency
5150 to 5250 MHz
Range
5725 to 5850 MHz
Modulation
CCK / OFDM / MIMO
802.11a: 14 dBm
Output Power 802.11b: 17 dBm
(Typical)
802.11g: 14 dBm
802.11n: 13 dBm
802.11a/g: 54 Mbps
Data rate
802.11b: 11 Mbps
802.11n: 300 Mbps
2402 to 2483 MHz: 1.17 dBi
Antenna Gain
5150 to 5250 MHz: 4.67 dBi
(Typical)
5725 to 5850 MHz: 3.30 dBi
Occupied
802.11a/b/g: HT20
bandwidth
802.11n: HT20/40
RF module(BM-LDS201) specification
(Only 47/55LW77**, 47/55LW95**, 47/55LW98**, 47/55LZ96**, 50/60PZ57**, 50PZ65**, 50/60PZ95**)
For TV by using a 2.4 GHz bandwidth radio frequency (RF).
yy
Output: 1 dBm or lower
yy
Maximum Communication Distance: 10 m (30 ft) in an open space
yy
Bandwidth: 2.4 GHz (2.4035 GHz - 2.4783 GHz)
yy
Transfer Rate: 250 kbps
yy
FCC ID of RF module inside TV.
FCC ID : BEJLDS201
ENGLISH
ENG
yy
Because band channel used by the country could be different, the user can not change or adjust the
operating frequency.
yy
FCC ID of Wi-Fi module inside TV.
FCC ID : BEJWN8522D1
150
IR CODES
IR CODES
(Depending on model)
Code
(Hexa)
Function
08
(POWER)
Note
Code
(Hexa)
Function
Note
Remote control Button
(Power On/Off)
B1
n
Remote control Button
95
ENERGY
SAVING
Remote control Button
B0

Remote control Button
30
AV MODE
Remote control Button
BA
yy /FREEZE
Remote control Button
0B
INPUT
Remote control Button
8E

Remote control Button
F0
TV/RAD
Remote control Button
8F

Remote control Button
10-19
Alphanumeric
buttons 0-9
Remote control Button
7E
SIMPLINK
Remote control Button
53
LIST
Remote control Button
79
RATIO
Remote control Button
1A
Q.VIEW
Remote control Button
BD
REC
Remote control Button
02
+
Remote control Button
AA
INFO
Remote control Button
03
-
Remote control Button
ENGLISH
ENG
1E
FAV/MARK/
CHAR/NUM
Remote control Button
DC
3D
Remote control Button
09
MUTE/DELETE
Remote control Button
00
P
/PAGE
Remote control Button
01
P
/PAGE
Remote control Button
59
PREMIUM
Remote control Button
43
Home
Remote control Button
45
Q.MENU /
3D OPTION
Remote control Button
40
Remote control Button
41
Remote control Button
07
<
Remote control Button
06
>
Remote control Button
44
OK
Remote control Button
28
BACK
Remote control Button
AB
GUIDE
Remote control Button
5B
EXIT
Remote control Button
72
RED button
Remote control Button
71
GREEN button
Remote control Button
63
YELLOW button
Remote control Button
61
BLUE button
Remote control Button
20
TEXT
Remote control Button
21
T.OPT(T.Option)
Remote control Button
39
SUBTITLE
Remote control Button
9E
LIVE TV
Remote control Button
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
151
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
RS-232C Setup
Type of connector;
D-Sub 9-Pin Male
Connect the RS-232C (serial port) input jack to an
external control device (such as a computer or an
A/V control system) to control the product’s functions externally.
Connect the serial port of the control device to the
RS-232C jack on the product back panel.
1
5
6
COMPONENT
IN 1
USB IN 2
USB IN 1
/DVI
IN 4
/DVI
IN 2
VIDEO
PR
AUDIO
R
L/MONO AUDIO R
L
RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE)
/DVI
PB
VIDEO
AV IN 1
IN 1
Y
WIRELESS
CONTROL
Pin name
No connection
RXD (Receive data)
TXD (Transmit data)
DTR (DTE side ready)
GND
DSR (DCE side ready)
RTS (Ready to send)
CTS (Clear to send)
No Connection
AV IN 2
LAN
AUDIO IN
RGB IN (PC) (RGB/DVI)
OPTICAL
PTICAL
TICAL DIGITAL
DIGIT
AUDIO OUT
ANTENNA/
ANTENNA
CABLE IN
AUDIO / VIDEO
COMPONENT IN 2
AUDIO / Y PB PR
H/P
ENGLISH
ENG
No.
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
/DVI
yy
RS-232C on this TV is intended to be used
with third party RS-232C control hardware
and software. The instructions below are
provided to help with programming software
or to test functionality using telenet software.
yy
RS-232C connection cables are not supplied
with the product.
9
IN 3
NOTE
152
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
RS-232C Configurations
Set ID
Set ID number. "Real Data Mapping" (See p.157)
7-Wire Configurations (Standard RS-232C cable)
RXD TXD
GND
DTR
DSR
RTS
CTS
PC
TV
2
3
5
4
6
7
8
3
2
5
6
4
8
7
D-Sub 9
D-Sub 9
TXD
RXD
GND
DSR
DTR
CTS
RTS
ENGLISH
ENG
RXD TXD
GND
DTR
DSR
RTS
CTS
PC
TV
2
3
5
4
6
7
8
3
2
5
6
4
7
8
D-Sub 9
D-Sub 9
2 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
SETUP and press OK.
3 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to
OPTION and press OK.
4 Press the Navigation buttons to scroll to Set ID
and press OK.
5 Scroll left or right to select a set ID number and
select Close. The adjustment range is 1 to 99.
6 When you are finished, press EXIT.
3-Wire Configurations(Not standard)
1 Press Home to access the Home menus.
TXD
RXD
GND
DTR
DSR
RTS
CTS
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
153
Communication Parameters
yy
Baud rate: 9600 bps (UART)
yy
Data length: 8 bits
yy
Parity : None
yy
Stop bit: 1 bit
yy
Communication code: ASCII code
yy
Use a crossed (reverse) cable.
Command reference list
COMMAND1
COMMAND2
DATA
(Hexadecimal)
COMMAND1
COMMAND2
DATA
(Hexadecimal)
k
a
00 to 01
14. Bass
k
s
00 to 64
02. Aspect
Ratio
k
c
(See p.154)
15. Balance
k
t
00 to 64
03. Screen
Mute
k
d
(See p.154)
16. Colour
Temperature
x
u
00 to 64
04. Volume
Mute
k
e
00 to 01
17. ISM
Method (Only
Plasma TV)
j
q
00 to 05
05. Volume
Control
k
f
00 to 64
18. Energy
Saving
j
q
00 to 05
06. Contrast
k
g
00 to 64
19. Auto Configuration
j
u
01
07. Brightness
k
h
00 to 64
20. Tune Command
m
a
(See p.157)
08. Colour
k
i
00 to 64
21. Programme m
Add/Skip
b
00 to 01
09. Tint
k
j
00 to 64
22. Key
m
c
Key Code
g
00 to 64
k
k
00 to 64
23. Control
m
Back Light
(Only LED LCD
TV)
11. OSD Select k
l
00 to 01
24. Input select x
(Main)
b
(See p.157)
12. Remote
Control
Lock Mode
k
m
00 to 01
25. 3D
x
t
(See p.158)
13. Treble
k
r
00 to 64
26. Extended
3D
x
v
(See p.158)
10. Sharpness
yy
Note : During USB operations such as DivX or EMF, all commands except Power(ka) and Key(mc)
are not executed and treated as NG.
ENGLISH
ENG
01. Power
154
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
Transmission / Receiving
Protocol
Transmission
[Command1][Command2][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
ENGLISH
ENG
[Command 1] First command to control the
TV.(j, k, m or x)
[Command 2] Second command to control the
TV.
[Set ID]
You can adjust the set ID to
choose desired monitor ID number in option menu. Adjustment
range is 1 to 99. When selecting Set ID ‘0’, every connected set is controlled. Set ID is indicated as decimal (1
to 99) on menu and as Hexa decimal (0x0 to 0x63) on transmission/receiving protocol.
[DATA]
To transmit command data.
Transmit ‘FF’ data to read status
of command.
[Cr]
Carriage Return
ASCII code ‘0x0D’
[ ]
ASCII code ‘space (0x20)’
OK Acknowledgement
[Command2][ ][Set ID][ ][OK][Data][x]
* The set transmits ACK (acknowledgement)
based on this format when receiving normal
data. At this time, if the data is data read mode,
it indicates present status data. If the data is
data write mode, it returns the data of the PC
computer.
01. Power (Command: k a)
►► To control Power On/Off of the set.
Transmission[k][a][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data 00 : Power Off
01 : Power On
Ack [a][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
►► To show Power On/Off.
Transmission [k][a][ ][Set ID][ ][FF][Cr]
Ack [a][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
* Similarly, if other functions transmit ‘0xFF’ data based
on this format, Acknowledgement data feed back
presents status about each function.
* OK Ack., Error Ack. and other message may display
on the screen when TV is power On.
02. Aspect Ratio (Command: k c) (Main Picture Size)
►► To adjust the screen format. (Main picture format)
You can also adjust the screen format using the
Aspect Ratio in the Q.MENU. or PICTURE menu.
Transmission [k][c][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data
01 :
02 :
06 :
07 :
09 :
0B :
10 to
Normal screen (4:3)
Wide screen (16:9)
Original
14:9
Just Scan
Full Wide
1F : Cinema Zoom 1 to 16
Ack [c][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
* Using the PC input, you select either 16:9 or 4:3
screen aspect ratio.
* In DTV/HDMI (1080i 50 Hz / 60 Hz, 720p 50Hz / 60
Hz, 1080p 24 Hz / 30 Hz / 50 Hz / 60 Hz),
Component( 720p, 1080i, 1080p 50 Hz / 60 Hz) mode,
Just Scan is available.
* Full Wide is supported only for DTV.
03. Screen Mute (Command: k d)
►► To select screen mute on/off.
Error Acknowledgement
[Command2][ ][Set ID][ ][NG][Data][x]
* The set transmits ACK (acknowledgement)
based on this format when receiving abnormal
data from
non-viable functions or communication errors.
Data00: Illegal Code
Transmission [k][d][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data 00 : Screen mute off (Picture on)
Video mute off
01 : Screen mute on (Picture off)
10 : Video mute on
Ack [d][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
* In case of video mute on only, TV will display On
Screen Display(OSD). But, in case of Screen mute
on, TV will not display OSD.
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
04. Volume Mute (Command: k e)
►► To control volume mute on/off.
You can also adjust mute using the MUTE button on
remote control.
Transmission [k][e][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data 00 : Volume mute on (Volume off)
01 : Volume mute off (Volume on)
Ack [e][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
05. Volume Control (Command: k f)
►► To adjust volume.
You can also adjust volume with the VOLUME buttons on remote control.
Transmission [k][f][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [f][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
155
09. Tint (Command: k j)
►► To adjust the screen tint.
You can also adjust tint in the PICTURE menu.
Transmission [k][j][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Red : 00 to Green : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [j][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
10. Sharpness (Command: k k)
►► To adjust the screen sharpness.
You can also adjust sharpness in the PICTURE menu.
Transmission [k][k][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [k][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
06. Contrast (Command: k g)
Transmission [k][g][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [g][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
11. OSD Select (Command: k l)
►► To select OSD (On Screen Display) on/off when controlling
remotely.
Transmission [k][l][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data00 : OSD off
01 : OSD on
Ack [l][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
07. Brightness (Command: k h)
►► To adjust screen brightness.
You can also adjust brightness in the PICTURE
menu.
Transmission [k][h][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [h][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
12. Remote control lock mode (Command: k m)
►► To lock the front panel controls on the monitor and remote
control.
Transmission [k][m][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
08. Colour (Command: k i)
►► To adjust the screen colour.
You can also adjust colour in the PICTURE menu.
Transmission [k][i][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [i][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
Data 00 : Lock off
01 : Lock on
Ack [m][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
* If you are not using the remote control, use this mode.
When main power is on/off, external control lock is
released.
* In the standby mode, if key lock is on, TV will not turn
on by power on key of IR & Local Key.
ENGLISH
ENG
►► To adjust screen contrast.
You can also adjust contrast in the PICTURE menu.
156
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
13. Treble (Command: k r)
17. ISM Method (Command: j p) (Only Plasma TV)
►► To adjust treble.
You can also adjust treble in the AUDIO menu.
►► To control the ISM method. You can also adjust ISM
Method in OPTION menu.
Transmission [k][r][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Transmission [j][p][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [r][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
Data
02:
04:
08:
20:
Orbiter
White wash
Normal
Colour Wash
Ack [p][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
14. Bass (Command: k s)
►► To adjust bass.
You can also adjust bass in the AUDIO menu.
Transmission [k][s][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [s][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
ENGLISH
ENG
15. Balance (Command: k t)
►► To adjust balance.
You can also adjust balance in the AUDIO menu.
Transmission [k][t][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
18. Energy Saving (Command: j q)
►► To reduce the power consumption of the TV. You can also
adjust Energy Saving in PICTURE menu.
Transmission [j][q][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Power Saving
Function
7
6
5
4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Ack [t][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
Level
Description
3
2
1
0
0
0
0
0
Off
0
0
0
1
Minimum
0
0
1
0
Medium
0
0
1
1
Maximum
0
1
0
1
Screen Off
Low
Power
0
1
0
0
Low
Power
0
1
0
Low
Power
Low
Power
Low
Power
Low
Power
Low
Power
Auto
(LED LCD
TV only)
Intelligent
Sensor
0
(Plasma TV
only)
Ack [q][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
16. Colour Temperature (Command: x u)
►► To adjust colour temperature. You can also adjust Colour
Temperature in the PICTURE menu.
Transmission [x][u][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
* Refer to ‘Real data mapping’. (See p.157)
Ack [u][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
19. Auto Configure(Command: j u)
►► To adjust picture position and minimize image shaking
automatically. It works only in RGB (PC) mode.
Transmission [j][u][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data 01: To set
Ack [u][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
20. Tune Command (Command: m a)
►► Select channel to following physical number.
Transmission [m][a][ ][Set ID][ ][Data0][ ][Data1][ ][Data2][Cr]
Data00 : High channel data
Data01 : Low channel data
ex. No. 47 -> 00 2F (2FH)
No. 394 -> 01 8A (18AH),
DTV No. 0 -> Don’t care
Data02 : 0x00 : Analogue Main
0x10 : DTV Main
0x20 : Radio
Channel data range
Analogue - Min: 00 to Max: C7 (0 to 199)
Digital - Min: 00 to Max: 3E7 (0 to 999)
Ack [a][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
Data Min: 00 to Max: 7DH
21. Programme Add/Skip(Command: m b)
Transmission [m][b][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data00 : Skip
24. Input select (Command: x b)
(Main Picture Input)
►► To select input source for main picture.
Transmission [x][b][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Structure
MSB
0
LSB
0
0
0
External Input
Input
0
0
1
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
Input Number
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
External
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Input Number
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0
Data
DTV
Analogue
AV
Component
RGB
HDMI
Data
Input1
Input2
Input3
Input4
01 : Add
Ack [b][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
Ack [b][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
* Real data mapping
22. Key(Command: m c)
00 :
Step 0
A:
Step 10 (Set ID 10)
F:
Step 15 (Set ID 15)
10 :
Step 16 (Set ID 16)
64 :
Step 100
►► To send IR remote key code.
Transmission [m][c][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Key code (See p.150)
Ack [c][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
23. Control Back Light(Command: m g) (Only LED
LCD TV)
►► To Control the back light.
Transmission [m][g][ ][Set ID][ ][Data][Cr]
Data Min : 00 to Max : 64
Ack [g][ ][Set ID][ ][OK/NG][Data][x]
6E : Step 110
73 :
Step 115
74 :
Step 116
CF : Step 199
FE : Step 254
FF : Step 255
0
ENGLISH
ENG
►► To set skip status for the current Programme.
157
158
EXTERNAL CONTROL DEVICE SETUP
25. 3D (Command: x t) (Only 3D models)
26. Extended 3D(Command: x v) (Only 3D models)
►► To change 3D mode for TV.
►► To change 3D mode for TV.
Transmission [x][v][ ][Set ID][ ][Data1][ ][Data2] [Cr]
Transmission [x][t][ ][Set ID][ ][Data1][ ][Data2][ ]
[Data3][ ][Data4][Cr]
Data01 : 3D option item that user wants to adjust
Data
00
01
02
03
04
05
Data01 00 : 3D On
01 : 3D Off
02 : 3D to 2D
03 : 2D to 3D
Data02 00 : Top and Bottom
01 : Side by Side
02 : Check Board
03 : Frame Sequential
Data02 : It has own range for each 3D option determined by Data01.
1) When Data 01 is 00(Picture Correction)
Data03 00 : Right to Left
01 : Left to Right
Data
00
01
Data04 3D Effect(3D Depth) : 0~20
ENGLISH
ENG
*If data01 is 00(3D On), data04 has no meaning.
*If data01 is 01(3D off) or 02(3D to 2D), data02, data03
and data04 have no meaning.
*If data01 is 03(2D to 3D), data02 and data03 have no
meaning.
Data 01
00
01
02
03
Data 02
O
X
X
X
Data 03
O
X
X
X
Data 04
X
X
X
O
X : don't care
Ack : All data must be consist of 2 characters.
[t][ ][OK] [Data1][ ][Data2][ ][Data3][ ][Data4] [x]
[t][ ][NG] [Data1] [x]
3D Option
Picture Correction(Picture Type)
Effect(Depth) (Only 2D to 3D)
Viewpoint
Picture Size (Only Plasma TV)
Picture Balance (Only Plasma TV)
Optimization (Only active type)
Picture Correction
Right to Left
Left to Right
2) When Data 01 is 01(Effect)
Data Min: 00 ~ Max: 14
(* transmit by Hexadecimal code)
3) When Data 01 is 02(Viewpoint)
Data Min: 00 ~ Max: 14
(* transmit by Hexadecimal code)
Data value range(0 to 20) converts Viewpoint range
(-10 to 10) automatically.
4) When Data01 is 03(Picture Size)
Data
00
01
Picture Size
Just Scan
16:9
5) When Data01 is 04(Picture Balance)
Data
00
01
Picture Size
Off
On
6) When Data01 is 05(Optimization)
Data Min: 00 ~ Max: 02
(* transmit by Hexadecimal code)
Ack : All data must be consist of 2 characters.
[v][ ][OK] [Data1][ ][Data2] [x]
[v][ ][NG] [Data1] [x]
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
159
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
Please be informed that LG Electronics products
may contain open source software listed in the
tables below.
License
Component
Apache license
bonjour
MIT license
cares
fontconfig
libcurl
libxml2
libxslt
lua interpreter
expat license
expat
Freetype license freetype
JPEG license
libjpeg
OpenSSL license openssl
portmap license
libmng
libpng
zlib
portmap
pixman license
pixman
X.net license
libicu
BSD license
netBSD
Simple XML Parser
xySSL
RSA Data secu- MD5
rity license
JSON license
JSON
MS92 license
snacc
License
Component
GNU GPL v2.0
Linux kernel 2.6
busybox
e2fsprogs
gdbserver
jfsutils
lzo
msdl 1.1
mtd-utils
ntpclient
procps
GNU LGPL v2.1 atk
directFB
ffmpeg
glib
gnuTLS
gail
GTK+
iconv
libintl
libgcrypt
libgpg-error
libgphoto2
libsoup
pango
pyenchant
qt
uClibc
webkit
MPL 1.1
cairo
nanox
mozilla firefox
zziplib
ENGLISH
ENG
Zlib/libpng
license
LG Electronics products may also contain open
source software listed as Components in the
table below, and you may download the complete
source code thereof free of charge, from LG
Electronics website (http://opensource.lge.com) for
a period of three (3) years from our last shipment
of this product. Please be informed that the open
source software is subject to the terms and conditions of the applicable open source licenses, which
are provided to you herein below.
160
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
Version 2, June 1991
Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 021101301, USA
Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies
of this license document, but changing it is not
allowed.
Preamble
ENGLISH
ENG
The licenses for most software are designed to
take away your freedom to share and change it.
By contrast, the GNU General Public License is
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and
change free software--to make sure the software
is free for all its users. This General Public License
applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's
software and to any other program whose authors
commit to using it. (Some other Free Software
Foundation software is covered by the GNU
Lesser General Public License instead.) You can
apply it to your programs, too.
When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public
Licenses are designed to make sure that you have
the freedom to distribute copies of free software
(and charge for this service if you wish), that you
receive source code or can get it if you want it,
that you can change the software or use pieces
of it in new free programs; and that you know you
can do these things.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights
or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you
if you distribute copies of the software, or if you
modify it.
For example, if you distribute copies of such a
program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must
give the recipients all the rights that you have. You
must make sure that they, too, receive or can get
the source code. And you must show them these
terms so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright
the software, and (2) offer you this license which
gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/
or modify the software.
Also, for each author's protection and ours, we
want to make certain that everyone understands
that there is no warranty for this free software.
If the software is modified by someone else and
passed on, we want its recipients to know that
what they have is not the original, so that any
problems introduced by others will not reflect on
the original authors' reputations.
Finally, any free program is threatened constantly
by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger
that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the
program proprietary. To prevent this, we have
made it clear that any patent must be licensed for
everyone's free use or not licensed at all.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License applies to any program or other
work which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under
the terms of this General Public License. The
"Program", below, refers to any such program or
work, and a "work based on the Program" means
either the Program or any derivative work under
copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the
Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with
modifications and/or translated into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without
limitation in the term "modification".) Each licensee
is addressed as "you".
Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this License; they are
outside its scope. The act of running the Program
is not restricted, and the output from the Program
is covered only if its contents constitute a work
based on the Program (independent of having
been made by running the Program). Whether that
is true depends on what the Program does.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies
of the Program's source code as you receive it, in
any medium, provided that you conspicuously and
appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate
copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep
intact all the notices that refer to this License and
to the absence of any warranty; and give any other
recipients of the Program a copy of this License
along with the Program.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the
Program or any portion of it, thus forming a work
based on the Program, and copy and distribute
such modifications or work under the terms of
Section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of
these conditions:
the same sections as part of a whole which is a
work based on the Program, the distribution of
the whole must be on the terms of this License,
whose permissions for other licensees extend to
the entire whole, and thus to each and every part
regardless of who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim
rights or contest your rights to work written entirely
by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to
control the distribution of derivative or collective
works based on the Program.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work not
based on the Program with the Program (or with
a work based on the Program) on a volume of a
storage or distribution medium does not bring the
other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may copy and distribute the Program (or a
work based on it, under Section 2) in object code
or executable form under the terms of Sections 1
and 2 above provided that you also do one of the
following:
b) You must cause any work that you distribute
or publish, that in whole or in part contains or is
derived from the Program or any part thereof, to be
licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties
under the terms of this License.
a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must
be distributed under the terms of Sections 1
and 2 above on a medium customarily used for
software interchange; or,
c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you must cause
it, when started running for such interactive use
in the most ordinary way, to print or display an
announcement including an appropriate copyright
notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or
else, saying that you provide a warranty) and that
users may redistribute the program under these
conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy
of this License. (Exception: if the Program itself is
interactive but does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on the Program is
not required to print an announcement.)
b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for
at least three years, to give any third party, for
a charge no more than your cost of physically
performing source distribution, a complete
machine-readable copy of the corresponding
source code, to be distributed under the terms
of Sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or,
These requirements apply to the modified work
as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are
not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works
in themselves, then this License, and its terms, do
not apply to those sections when you distribute
them as separate works. But when you distribute
c) Accompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is allowed
only for noncommercial distribution and only
if you received the program in object code or
executable form with such an offer, in accord
with Subsection b above.)
The source code for a work means the preferred
form of the work for making modifications to it. For
an executable work, complete source code means
all the source code for all modules it contains, plus
ENGLISH
ENG
a) You must cause the modified files to carry
prominent notices stating that you changed the
files and the date of any change.
161
162
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
any associated interface definition files, plus the
scripts used to control compilation and installation
of the executable. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include
anything that is normally distributed (in either
source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating
system on which the executable runs, unless that
component itself accompanies the executable.
If distribution of executable or object code is made
by offering access to copy from a designated
place, then offering equivalent access to copy
the source code from the same place counts as
distribution of the source code, even though third
parties are not compelled to copy the source along
with the object code.
ENGLISH
ENG
4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as expressly provided
under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy,
modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is
void, and will automatically terminate your rights
under this License. However, parties who have
received copies, or rights, from you under this
License will not have their licenses terminated so
long as such parties remain in full compliance.
5. You are not required to accept this License,
since you have not signed it. However, nothing
else grants you permission to modify or distribute
the Program or its derivative works. These actions
are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing
the Program (or any work based on the Program),
you indicate your acceptance of this License to
do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Program or works
based on it.
son (not limited to patent issues), conditions are
imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so
as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under
this License and any other pertinent obligations,
then as a consequence you may not distribute the
Program at all. For example, if a patent license
would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the
Program by all those who receive copies directly or
indirectly through you, then the only way you could
satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
entirely from distribution of the Program.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance,
the balance of the section is intended to apply and
the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you
to infringe any patents or other property right
claims or to contest validity of any such claims;
this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
integrity of the free software distribution system,
which is implemented by public license practices.
Many people have made generous contributions to
the wide range of software distributed through that
system in reliance on consistent application of that
system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he
or she is willing to distribute software through any
other system and a licensee cannot impose that
choice.
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear
what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of
this License.
6. Each time you redistribute the Program (or
any work based on the Program), the recipient
automatically receives a license from the original
licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program
subject to these terms and conditions. You may
not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are
not responsible for enforcing compliance by third
parties to this License.
8. If the distribution and/or use of the Program is
restricted in certain countries either by patents or
by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright
holder who places the Program under this License
may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not
thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this
License.
7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other rea-
9. The Free Software Foundation may publish
revised and/or new versions of the General Public
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
License from time to time. Such new versions
will be similar in spirit to the present version, but
may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
Each version is given a distinguishing version
number. If the Program specifies a version number
of this License which applies to it and "any later
version", you have the option of following the
terms and conditions either of that version or of
any later version published by the Free Software
Foundation. If the Program does not specify a
version number of this License, you may choose
any version ever published by the Free Software
Foundation.
NO WARRANTY
11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED
FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT
WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS"
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK
AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF
THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE
PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME
THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING,
REPAIR OR CORRECTION.
12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY
APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY
OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAM-
AGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO
USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT
LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES
SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR
A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE
WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF
SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
ENGLISH
ENG
10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Program into other free programs whose distribution
conditions are different, write to the author to ask
for permission. For software which is copyrighted
by the Free Software Foundation, write to the
Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make
exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by
the two goals of preserving the free status of all
derivatives of our free software and of promoting
the sharing and reuse of software generally.
163
164
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
GNU Lesser General Public License
Version 2.1, February 1999
Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
02111-1307 USA Everyone is permitted to copy
and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed.
[This is the first released version of the Lesser
GPL. It also counts as the successor of the GNU
Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.]
ENGLISH
ENG
Preamble
The licenses for most software are designed to
take away your freedom to share and change it.
By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are
intended to guarantee your freedom to share and
change free software--to make sure the software is
free for all its users.
This license, the Lesser General Public License,
applies to some specially designated software
packages--typically libraries--of the Free Software
Foundation and other authors who decide to use
it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think
carefully about whether this license or the ordinary
General Public License is the better strategy to
use in any particular case, based on the explanations below.
When we speak of free software, we are referring
to freedom of use, not price. Our General Public
Licenses are designed to make sure that you have
the freedom to distribute copies of free software
(and charge for this service if you wish); that you
receive source code or can get it if you want it; that
you can change the software and use pieces of it
in new free programs; and that you are informed
that you can do these things.
whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the
recipients all the rights that we gave you. You
must make sure that they, too, receive or can get
the source code. If you link other code with the
library, you must provide complete object files to
the recipients, so that they can relink them with the
library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them these terms
so they know their rights.
We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1)
we copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this
license, which gives you legal permission to copy,
distribute and/or modify the library.
To protect each distributor, we want to make it very
clear that there is no warranty for the free library.
Also, if the library is modified by someone else and
passed on, the recipients should know that what
they have is not the original version, so that the
original author's reputation will not be affected by
problems that might be introduced by others.
Finally, software patents pose a constant threat
to the existence of any free program. We wish
to make sure that a company cannot effectively
restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a
restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore,
we insist that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full
freedom of use specified in this license.
Most GNU software, including some libraries,
is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public
License. This license, the GNU Lesser General
Public License, applies to certain designated
libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary
General Public License. We use this license for
certain libraries in order to permit linking those
libraries into non-free programs.
To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these
rights or to ask you to surrender these rights.
These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or
if you modify it.
When a program is linked with a library, whether
statically or using a shared library, the combination
of the two is legally speaking a combined work,
a derivative of the original library. The ordinary
General Public License therefore permits such
linking only if the entire combination fits its criteria
of freedom. The Lesser General Public License
permits more lax criteria for linking other code with
the library.
For example, if you distribute copies of the library,
We call this license the "Lesser" General Public
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
License because it does Less to protect the user's
freedom than the ordinary General Public License.
It also provides other free software developers
Less of an advantage over competing non-free
programs. These disadvantages are the reason we
use the ordinary General Public License for many
libraries. However, the Lesser license provides
advantages in certain special circumstances.
For example, on rare occasions, there may be a
special need to encourage the widest possible use
of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto
standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must
be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case
is that a free library does the same job as widely
used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little
to gain by limiting the free library to free software
only, so we use the Lesser General Public License.
Although the Lesser General Public License is
Less protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with
the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal
to run that program using a modified version of the
Library.
The precise terms and conditions for copying,
distribution and modification follow. Pay close
attention to the difference between a "work based
on the library" and a "work that uses the library".
The former contains code derived from the library,
whereas the latter must be combined with the
library in order to run.
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION
0. This License Agreement applies to any software
library or other program which contains a notice
placed by the copyright holder or other authorized
party saying it may be distributed under the terms
of this Lesser General Public License (also called
"this License"). Each licensee is addressed as
"you".
A "library" means a collection of software functions
and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently
linked with application programs (which use some
of those functions and data) to form executables.
The "Library", below, refers to any such software
library or work which has been distributed under
these terms. A "work based on the Library" means
either the Library or any derivative work under
copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the
Library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with
modifications and/or translated straightforwardly
into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is
included without limitation in the term "modification".)
"Source code" for a work means the preferred
form of the work for making modifications to it.
For a library, complete source code means all the
source code for all modules it contains, plus any
associated interface definition files, plus the scripts
used to control compilation and installation of the
library.
Activities other than copying, distribution and
modification are not covered by this License; they
are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output
from such a program is covered only if its contents
constitute a work based on the Library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it).
Whether that is true depends on what the Library
does and what the program that uses the Library
does.
1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of
the Library's complete source code as you receive
it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously
and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty;
keep intact all the notices that refer to this License
and to the absence of any warranty; and distribute
a copy of this License along with the Library.
You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer
warranty protection in exchange for a fee.
2. You may modify your copy or copies of the
Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work
ENGLISH
ENG
In other cases, permission to use a particular
library in non-free programs enables a greater
number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C
Library in non-free programs enables many more
people to use the whole GNU operating system,
as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating
system.
165
166
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
based on the Library, and copy and distribute such
modifications or work under the terms of Section
1 above, provided that you also meet all of these
conditions:
a) The modified work must itself be a software
library.
b) You must cause the files modified to carry
prominent notices stating that you changed the
files and the date of any change.
c) You must cause the whole of the work to be
licensed at no charge to all third parties under
the terms of this License.
ENGLISH
ENG
d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a
function or a table of data to be supplied by an
application program that uses the facility, other
than as an argument passed when the facility
is invoked, then you must make a good faith
effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the
facility still operates, and performs whatever
part of its purpose remains meaningful.
(For example, a function in a library to compute
square roots has a purpose that is entirely
well-defined independent of the application.
Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any
application-supplied function or table used by
this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function
must still compute square roots.)
These requirements apply to the modified work
as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work
are not derived from the Library, and can be
reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this License,
and its terms, do not apply to those sections
when you distribute them as separate works.
But when you distribute the same sections as
part of a whole which is a work based on the
Library, the distribution of the whole must be on
the terms of this License, whose permissions
for other licensees extend to the entire whole,
and thus to each and every part regardless of
who wrote it.
Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim
rights or contest your rights to work written
entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise
the right to control the distribution of derivative
or collective works based on the Library.
In addition, mere aggregation of another work
not based on the Library with the Library (or with
a work based on the Library) on a volume of a
storage or distribution medium does not bring the
other work under the scope of this License.
3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this
License to a given copy of the Library. To do this,
you must alter all the notices that refer to this
License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU
General Public License, version 2, instead of to
this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of
the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify that version instead if
you wish.) Do not make any other change in these
notices.
Once this change is made in a given copy, it is
irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU
General Public License applies to all subsequent
copies and derivative works made from that copy.
This option is useful when you wish to copy part of
the code of the Library into a program that is not a
library.
4. You may copy and distribute the Library (or
a portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in
object code or executable form under the terms
of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you
accompany it with the complete corresponding
machine-readable source code, which must be
distributed under the terms of Sections 1 and 2
above on a medium customarily used for software
interchange.
If distribution of object code is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code
from the same place satisfies the requirement to
distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along
with the object code.
5. A program that contains no derivative of any
portion of the Library, but is designed to work with
the Library by being compiled or linked with it,
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
is called a "work that uses the Library". Such a
work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the
Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this
License.
However, linking a "work that uses the Library" with
the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions
of the Library), rather than a "work that uses the
library". The executable is therefore covered by
this License. Section 6 states terms for distribution
of such executables.
When a "work that uses the Library" uses material
from a header file that is part of the Library, the
object code for the work may be a derivative work
of the Library even though the source code is not.
Whether this is true is especially significant if the
work can be linked without the Library, or if the
work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be
true is not precisely defined by law.
167
among them, as well as a reference directing the
user to the copy of this License. Also, you must do
one of these things:
a) Accompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for
the Library including whatever changes were
used in the work (which must be distributed
under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the
work is an executable linked with the Library,
with the complete machine-readable "work
that uses the Library", as object code and/or
source code, so that the user can modify the
Library and then relink to produce a modified
executable containing the modified Library. (It
is understood that the user who changes the
contents of definitions files in the Library will
not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.)
Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the Library,
you may distribute the object code for the work
under the terms of Section 6. Any executables containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether
or not they are linked directly with the Library itself.
c) Accompany the work with a written offer,
valid for at least three years, to give the same
user the materials specified in Subsection 6a,
above, for a charge no more than the cost of
performing this distribution.
6. As an exception to the Sections above, you may
also combine or link a "work that uses the Library"
with the Library to produce a work containing portions of the Library, and distribute that work under
terms of your choice, provided that the terms
permit modification of the work for the customer's
own use and reverse engineering for debugging
such modifications.
d) If distribution of the work is made by offering
access to copy from a designated place, offer
equivalent access to copy the above specified
materials from the same place.
You must give prominent notice with each copy of
the work that the Library is used in it and that the
Library and its use are covered by this License.
You must supply a copy of this License. If the work
during execution displays copyright notices, you
must include the copyright notice for the Library
e) Verify that the user has already received
a copy of these materials or that you have
already sent this user a copy.
For an executable, the required form of the "work
that uses the Library" must include any data and
utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception,
the materials to be distributed need not include
anything that is normally distributed (in either
ENGLISH
ENG
If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessors, and
small macros and small inline functions (ten lines
or less in length), then the use of the object file
is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally
a derivative work. (Executables containing this
object code plus portions of the Library will still fall
under Section 6.)
b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for
linking with the Library. A suitable mechanism
is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the
library already present on the user's computer system, rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2) will operate
properly with a modified version of the library,
if the user installs one, as long as the modified
version is interface-compatible with the version
that the work was made with.
168
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
source or binary form) with the major components
(compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating
system on which the executable runs, unless that
component itself accompanies the executable.
It may happen that this requirement contradicts
the license restrictions of other proprietary libraries
that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use
both them and the Library together in an executable that you distribute.
7. You may place library facilities that are a work
based on the Library side-by-side in a single
library together with other library facilities not
covered by this License, and distribute such a
combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the
other library facilities is otherwise permitted, and
provided that you do these two things:
ENGLISH
ENG
a) Accompany the combined library with a copy
of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must
be distributed under the terms of the Sections
above.
b) Give prominent notice with the combined
library of the fact that part of it is a work based
on the Library, and explaining where to find the
accompanying uncombined form of the same
work.
8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link
with, or distribute the Library except as expressly
provided under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or
distribute the Library is void, and will automatically
terminate your rights under this License. However,
parties who have received copies, or rights, from
you under this License will not have their licenses
terminated so long as such parties remain in full
compliance.
9. You are not required to accept this License,
since you have not signed it. However, nothing
else grants you permission to modify or distribute
the Library or its derivative works. These actions
are prohibited by law if you do not accept this
License. Therefore, by modifying or distributing
the Library (or any work based on the Library), you
indicate your acceptance of this License to do so,
and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the Library or works based on it.
10. Each time you redistribute the Library (or any
work based on the Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor
to copy, distribute, link with or modify the Library
subject to these terms and conditions. You may
not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are
not responsible for enforcing compliance by third
parties with this License.
11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are
imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of
this License, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this License. If you cannot distribute so
as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under
this License and any other pertinent obligations,
then as a consequence you may not distribute
the Library at all. For example, if a patent license
would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the
Library by all those who receive copies directly or
indirectly through you, then the only way you could
satisfy both it and this License would be to refrain
entirely from distribution of the Library.
If any portion of this section is held invalid or
unenforceable under any particular circumstance,
the balance of the section is intended to apply, and
the section as a whole is intended to apply in other
circumstances.
It is not the purpose of this section to induce you
to infringe any patents or other property right
claims or to contest validity of any such claims;
this section has the sole purpose of protecting the
integrity of the free software distribution system
which is implemented by public license practices.
Many people have made generous contributions to
the wide range of software distributed through that
system in reliance on consistent application of that
system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he
or she is willing to distribute software through any
other system and a licensee cannot impose that
choice.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
This section is intended to make thoroughly clear
what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of
this License.
12. If the distribution and/or use of the Library is
restricted in certain countries either by patents or
by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright
holder who places the Library under this License
may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not
thus excluded. In such case, this License incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this
License.
13. The Free Software Foundation may publish
revised and/or new versions of the Lesser General
Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version,
but may differ in detail to address new problems or
concerns.
14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the Library
into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the
author to ask for permission. For software which
is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation,
write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will
be guided by the two goals of preserving the free
status of all derivatives of our free software and
of promoting the sharing and reuse of software
generally.
NO WARRANTY
15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED
FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT
PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT
WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING
THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER
PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS"
WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER
EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS
TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE
LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY
PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST
OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR
CORRECTION.
16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY
APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY
OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR
REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL,
INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO
USE THE LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED
BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF
THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER
SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR
OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
How to Apply These Terms to Your New Libraries
If you develop a new library, and you want it to
be of the greatest possible use to the public, we
recommend making it free software that everyone
can redistribute and change. You can do so by
permitting redistribution under these terms (or,
alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary General Public License).
To apply these terms, attach the following notices
to the library. It is safest to attach them to the start
of each source file to most effectively convey the
exclusion of warranty; and each file should have
at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where
the full notice is found.
<one line to give the library's name and an idea
of what it does.> Copyright (C) <year> <name
ENGLISH
ENG
Each version is given a distinguishing version
number. If the Library specifies a version number
of this License which applies to it and "any later
version", you have the option of following the
terms and conditions either of that version or of
any later version published by the Free Software
Foundation. If the Library does not specify a
license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation.
169
170
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
of author>
This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the
GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either
version 2.1 of the License, or (at your option)
any later version.
This library is distributed in the hope that it will
be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY;
without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General
Public License for more details.
You should have received a copy of the GNU
Lesser General Public License along with this
library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston, MA
02111-1307 USA
ENGLISH
ENG
Also add information on how to contact you by
electronic and paper mail.
You should also get your employer (if you work
as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a
"copyright disclaimer" for the library, if necessary.
Here is a sample; alter the names:
Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright
interest in the library `Frob' (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker.
signature of Ty Coon, 1 April 1990
Ty Coon, President of Vice
That's all there is to it!
Mozilla Public License 1.1 (MPL
1.1)
1. Definitions.
1.0.1. "Commercial Use"
means distribution or otherwise making the Covered Code available to a third party.
1.1. ''Contributor''
means each entity that creates or contributes to
the creation of Modifications.
1.2. ''Contributor Version''
means the combination of the Original Code, prior
Modifications used by a Contributor, and the Modifications made by that particular Contributor.
1.3. ''Covered Code''
means the Original Code or Modifications or the
combination of the Original Code and Modifications, in each case including portions thereof.
1.4. ''Electronic Distribution Mechanism''
means a mechanism generally accepted in the
software development community for the electronic transfer of data.
1.5. ''Executable''
means Covered Code in any form other than
Source Code.
1.6. ''Initial Developer''
means the individual or entity identified as the Initial Developer in the Source Code notice required
by Exhibit A.
1.7. ''Larger Work''
means a work which combines Covered Code or
portions thereof with code not governed by the
terms of this License.
1.8. ''License''
means this document.
1.8.1. "Licensable"
means having the right to grant, to the maximum
extent possible, whether at the time of the initial
grant or subsequently
acquired, any and all of the rights conveyed
herein.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
1.9. ''Modifications''
means any addition to or deletion from the substance or structure of either the Original Code or
any previous Modifications. When Covered Code
is released as a series of files, a Modification
is:
(a) Any addition to or deletion from the contents
of a file containing Original Code or previous
Modifications.
(b) Any new file that contains any part of the
Original Code or previous Modifications.
1.10. ''Original Code''
means Source Code of computer software code
which is described in the Source Code notice
required by Exhibit A as Original Code, and which,
at the time of its release under this License is not
already Covered Code governed by this License.
1.11. ''Source Code''
means the preferred form of the Covered Code for
making modifications to it, including all modules it
contains, plus any associated interface definition
files, scripts used to control compilation and installation of an Executable, or source code differential
comparisons against either the Original Code or
another well known, available Covered Code of the
Contributor's choice. The Source Code can be in a
compressed
or archival form, provided the appropriate decompression or de-archiving software is widely available for no charge.
1.12. "You'' (or "Your")
means an individual or a legal entity exercising
rights under, and complying with all of the terms
of, this License or a future version of this License
issued under Section 6.1.For legal entities, "You''
includes any entity which controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with You. For
purposes of this definition, "control'' means (a) the
power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or
management of such entity, whether by contract or
otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty per-
cent (50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial
ownership of such entity.
2. Source Code License.
2.1. The Initial Developer Grant.
The Initial Developer hereby grants You a worldwide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license, subject to
third party intellectual property claims:
(a) under intellectual property rights (other
than patent or trademark) Licensable by Initial
Developer to use, reproduce, modify, display,
perform, sublicense and distribute the Original
Code (or portions thereof) with or without Modifications, and/or as part of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patents Claims infringed by the making, using or selling of Original Code, to make,
have made, use, practice, sell, and offer for
sale, and/or otherwise dispose of the Original
Code (or portions thereof).
(c) the licenses granted in this Section 2.1(a)
and (b) are effective on the date Initial Developer first distributes Original Code under the
terms of this License.
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.1(b) above, no
patent license is granted: 1) for code that You
delete from the Original Code; 2) separate
from the Original Code; or 3) for infringements
caused by: i) the modification of the Original
Code or ii) the combination of the Original
Code with other software or devices.
2.2. Contributor Grant.
Subject to third party intellectual property claims,
each Contributor hereby grants You a world-wide,
royalty-free, non-exclusive license
(a) under intellectual property rights (other than
patent or trademark) Licensable by Contributor, to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform,
sublicense and distribute the Modifications created by such Contributor (or portions thereof)
either on an unmodified basis, with other
Modifications, as Covered Code and/or as part
of a Larger Work; and
(b) under Patent Claims infringed by the making, using, or selling of Modifications made by
ENGLISH
ENG
1.10.1. "Patent Claims"
means any patent claim(s), now owned or hereafter acquired, including without limitation, method,
process, and apparatus claims, in any patent
Licensable by grantor.
171
172
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
that Contributor either alone and/or in combination with its Contributor Version (or portions
of such combination), to make, use, sell, offer
for sale, have made, and/or otherwise dispose
of: 1) Modifications made by that Contributor
(or portions thereof); and 2) the combination
of Modifications made by that Contributor with
its Contributor Version (or portions of such
combination).
(c) the licenses granted in Sections 2.2(a) and
2.2(b) are effective on the date Contributor first
makes Commercial Use of the Covered Code.
ENGLISH
ENG
(d) Notwithstanding Section 2.2(b) above, no
patent license is granted: 1) for any code that
Contributor has deleted from the Contributor Version; 2) separate from the Contributor
Version; 3) for infringements caused by: i) third
party modifications of Contributor Version or ii)
the combination of Modifications made by that
Contributor with other software (except as part
of the Contributor Version) or other devices; or
4) under Patent Claims infringed by Covered
Code in the absence of Modifications made by
that Contributor.
3. Distribution Obligations.
3.1. Application of License.
The Modifications which You create or to which
You contribute are governed by the terms of this
License, including without limitation Section 2.2.
The Source Code version of Covered Code may
be distributed only under the terms of this License
or a future version of this License released under
Section 6.1, and You must include a copy of this
License with every copy of the Source Code You
distribute. You may not offer or impose any terms
on any Source Code version that alters or restricts
the applicable version of this License or the recipients' rights hereunder. However, You may include
an additional document offering the additional
rights described in Section 3.5.
3.2. Availability of Source Code.
Any Modification which You create or to which You
contribute must be made available in Source Code
form under the terms of this License either on the
same media as an Executable version or via an
accepted Electronic Distribution Mechanism to
anyone to whom you made an Executable version
available; and if made available via Electronic
Distribution Mechanism,
must remain available for at least twelve (12)
months after the date it initially became available,
or at least six (6) months after a subsequent version of that particular Modification has been made
available to such recipients. You are responsible
for ensuring that the Source Code version remains
available even if the Electronic Distribution Mechanism is maintained by a third party.
3.3. Description of Modifications.
You must cause all Covered Code to which You
contribute to contain a file documenting the changes You made to create that Covered Code and the
date of any change. You must include a prominent
statement that the Modification is derived, directly
or indirectly, from Original Code provided by the
Initial Developer and including the name of the
Initial Developer in (a) the Source Code, and (b)
in any notice in an Executable version or related
documentation in which You describe the origin or
ownership of the Covered Code.
3.4. Intellectual Property Matters
(a) Third Party Claims.
If Contributor has knowledge that a license under a
third party's intellectual property rights is required
to exercise the rights granted by such Contributor
under Sections 2.1 or 2.2, Contributor must include
a text file with the Source Code distribution titled
"LEGAL'' which describes the claim and the party
making the claim in sufficient detail that a recipient
will know whom to contact. If Contributor obtains
such knowledge after the Modification is made
available as described in Section 3.2, Contributor
shall promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies
Contributor makes available thereafter and shall
take other steps (such as notifying appropriate
mailing lists or newsgroups) reasonably calculated
to inform those who received the Covered Code
that new knowledge has been obtained.
(b) Contributor APIs.
If Contributor's Modifications include an application programming interface and Contributor has
knowledge of patent licenses which are reasonably
necessary to implement that API, Contributor must
also include this information in the LEGAL file.
(c) Representations.
Contributor represents that, except as disclosed
pursuant to Section 3.4(a) above, Contribu tor
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
believes that Contributor's Modifications are
Contributor's original creation(s) and/or Contributor
has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by
this License.
3.6. Distribution of Executable Versions.
You may distribute Covered Code in Executable
form only if the requirements of Section 3.1-3.5
have been met for that Covered Code, and if You
include a notice stating that the Source Code version of the Covered Code is available under the
terms of this License, including a description of
how and where You have fulfilled the obligations
of Section 3.2. The notice must be conspicuously
included in any notice in an Executable version,
related documentation or collateral in which You
describe recipients' rights relating to the Covered
Code. You may distribute the Executable version
of Covered Code or ownership rights under a
license of Your choice, which may contain terms
different from this License, provided that You are
in compliance with the terms of this License and
that the license for the Executable version does
not attempt to limit or alter the recipient's rights in
the Source Code version from the rights set forth
in this License. If You distribute the Executable
version under a different license You must make
it absolutely clear that any terms which differ from
this License are offered by You alone, not by the
Initial Developer or any Contributor. You hereby
agree to indemnify the Initial Developer and every
Contributor for any liability incurred by the Initial
Developer or such Contributor as a result of any
such terms You offer.
3.7. Larger Works.
You may create a Larger Work by combining
Covered Code with other code not governed by
the terms of this License and distribute the Larger
Work as a single product. In such a case, You
must make sure the requirements of this License
are fulfilled for the Covered Code.
4. Inability to Comply Due to Statute or Regulation.
If it is impossible for You to comply with any of the
terms of this License with respect to some or all
of the Covered Code due to statute, judicial order,
or regulation then You must: (a) comply with the
terms of this License to the maximum extent possible; and (b) describe the limitations and the code
they affect. Such description must be included in
the LEGAL file described in Section 3.4 and must
be included with all distributions of the Source
Code. Except to the extent prohibited by statute
or regulation, such description must be sufficiently
detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able
to understand it.
5. Application of this License.
This License applies to code to which the Initial
Developer has attached the notice in Exhibit A and
to related Covered Code.
6. Versions of the License.
6.1. New Versions.
Netscape Communications Corporation (''Netscape'') may publish revised and/or new versions
of the License from time to time. Each version will
be given a distinguishing version number.
6.2. Effect of New Versions.
Once Covered Code has been published under a
particular version of the License, You may always
continue to use it under the terms of that version.
You may also choose to use such Covered Code
ENGLISH
ENG
3.5. Required Notices.
You must duplicate the notice in Exhibit A in each
file of the Source Code. If it is not possible to put
such notice in a particular
Source Code file due to its structure, then You
must include such notice in a location (such as a
relevant directory) where a user would be likely
to look for such a notice. If You created one or
more Modification(s) You may add your name as
a Contributor to the notice described in Exhibit
A. You must also duplicate this License in any
documentation for the Source Code where You
describe recipients' rights or ownership rights
relating to Covered Code. You may choose to
offer, and to charge a fee for, warranty, support,
indemnity or liability obligations to one or more
recipients of Covered Code. However, You may do
so only on Your own behalf, and not on behalf of
the Initial Developer or any Contributor You must
make it absolutely clear than any such warranty,
support, indemnity or liability obligation is offered
by You alone, and You hereby agree to indemnify
the Initial Developer and every Contributor for any
liability incurred by the Initial Developer or such
Contributor as a result of warranty, support, indemnity or liability terms You offer.
173
174
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
under the terms of any subsequent version of the
License published by Netscape. No one other than
Netscape has the right to modify the terms applicable to Covered Code created under this License.
6.3. Derivative Works.
If You create or use a modified version of this
License (which you may only do in order to apply
it to code which is not already Covered Code governed by this License), You must (a) rename Your
license so that the phrases ''Mozilla'', ''MOZILLAPL'', ''MOZPL'', ''Netscape'', "MPL", ''NPL'' or
any confusingly similar phrase do not appear
in your license (except to note that your license
differs from this License) and (b) otherwise make
it clear that Your version of the license contains
terms which differ from the Mozilla Public License
and Netscape Public License. (Filling in the name
of the Initial Developer, Original Code or Contributor in the notice described in Exhibit A shall not of
themselves be deemed to be modifications of this
License.)
ENGLISH
ENG
7. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY.
COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS
LICENSE ON AN "AS IS'' BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,
WARRANTIES THAT THE COVERED CODE IS
FREE OF DEFECTS, MERCHANTABLE, FIT FOR
A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGING.
THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND
PERFORMANCE OF THE COVERED CODE IS
WITH YOU. SHOULD ANY COVERED CODE
PROVE DEFECTIVE IN ANY RESPECT, YOU
(NOT THE INITIAL DEVELOPER OR ANY OTHER
CONTRIBUTOR) ASSUME THE COST OF ANY
NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY
CONSTITUTES AN ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS
LICENSE. NO USE OF ANY COVERED CODE IS
AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER
THIS DISCLAIMER.
8. TERMINATION.
8.1. This License and the rights granted hereunder
will terminate automatically if You fail to comply
with terms herein and fail
to cure such breach within 30 days of becoming aware of the breach. All sublicenses to the
Covered Code which are properly granted shall
survive any termination of this License. Provisions
which, by their nature, must remain in effect beyond the termination of this License shall survive.
8.2. If You initiate litigation by asserting a patent
infringement claim (excluding declatory judgment
actions) against Initial Developer or a Contributor
(the Initial Developer or Contributor against whom
You file such action is referred to as "Participant")
alleging that:
(a) such Participant's Contributor Version
directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then
any and all rights granted by such Participant to You under Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 of
this License shall, upon 60 days notice from
Participant terminate prospectively, unless if
within 60 days after receipt of notice You either:
(i) agree in writing to pay Participant a mutually agreeable reasonable royalty for Your past
and future use of Modifications made by such
Participant, or (ii) withdraw Your litigation claim
with respect to the Contributor Version against
such Participant. If within 60 days of notice, a
reasonable royalty and payment arrangement
are not mutually agreed upon in writing by the
parties or the litigation claim is not withdrawn,
the rights granted by Participant to You under
Sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 automatically terminate
at the expiration of the 60 day notice period
specified above.
(b) any software, hardware, or device, other
than such Participant's Contributor Version,
directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then
any rights granted to You by such Participant
under Sections 2.1(b) and 2.2(b) are revoked
effective as of the date You first made, used,
sold, distributed, or had made, Modifications
made by that Participant.
8.3. If You assert a patent infringement claim
against Participant alleging that such Participant's
Contributor Version directly or indirectly infringes
any patent where such claim is resolved (such as
by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of
patent infringement litigation, then the reasonable
value of the licenses granted by such Participant
under Sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken into account in determining the amount or value of any
payment or license. 8.4. In the event of termination under Sections 8.1 or 8.2 above, all end user
license agreements (excluding distributors and
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
resellers) which have been validly granted by You
or any distributor hereunder prior to termination
shall survive termination.
10. U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS.
The Covered Code is a ''commercial item,'' as that
term is defined in 48 C.F.R. 2.101 (Oct. 1995),
consisting of ''commercial computer software'' and
''commercial computer software documentation,''
as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 (Sept.
1995). Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 and 48
C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4 (June
1995), all U.S. Government End Users acquire
Covered Code with only those rights set forth
herein.
11. MISCELLANEOUS.
This License represents the complete agreement
concerning subject matter hereof. If any provision
of this License is held to be unenforceable, such
provision shall be reformed only to the extent necessary to make it enforceable. This License shall
be governed by California law provisions (except
to the extent applicable law, if any, provides otherwise), excluding its conflict-of-law provisions. With
respect to disputes in which at least one party is
a citizen of, or an entity chartered or registered to
do business in the United States of America, any
litigation relating to this License shall be subject to
the jurisdiction of the Federal Courts of the Northern District of California, with venue lying in Santa
Clara County, California, with the losing party
responsible for costs, including without limitation,
court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees and
expenses. The application of the United Nations
Convention on Contracts for the International Sale
of Goods is expressly excluded. Any law or regulation which provides that the language of a contract
shall be construed against the drafter shall not
apply to this License.
12. RESPONSIBILITY FOR CLAIMS.
As between Initial Developer and the Contributors,
each party is responsible for claims and damages
arising, directly or indirectly, out of its utilization of
rights under this License and You agree to work
with Initial Developer and Contributors to distribute
such responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing
herein is intended or shall be deemed to constitute
any admission of liability.
13. MULTIPLE-LICENSED CODE.
Initial Developer may designate portions of the
Covered Code as Multiple-Licensed. MultipleLicensed means that the Initial Developer permits
you to utilize portions of the Covered Code under
Your choice of the MPL or the alternative licenses,
if any, specified by the Initial Developer in the file
described in Exhibit A.
EXHIBIT A -Mozilla Public License.
``The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla
Public License
Version 1.1 (the "License"); you may not use this
file except in
compliance with the License. You may obtain a
copy of the License at
http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/
Software distributed under the License is distributed on an "AS IS"
basis, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
either express or implied. See the
License for the specific language governing rights
and limitations under the License.
ENGLISH
ENG
9. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY.
UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO
LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER TORT (INCLUDING
NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE,
SHALL YOU, THE INITIAL DEVELOPER, ANY
OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY DISTRIBUTOR
OF COVERED CODE, OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY
OF SUCH PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON
FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION,
DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL, WORK
STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF SUCH
PARTY SHALL HAVE BEEN INFORMED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO
LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY
RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY'S NEGLIGENCE
TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW PROHIBITS
SUCH LIMITATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO
NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION
OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THIS EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION
MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
175
176
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
The Original Code is _______________________
_______________.
The Initial Developer of the Original Code is
________________________.
Portions created by ______________________
are Copyright (C) ______
_______________________.All Rights Reserved.
Contributor(s): ____________________________
__________.
ENGLISH
ENG
Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used
under the terms
of the _____ license (the [___] License), in which
case the
provisions of [______] License are applicable
instead of those
above.If you wish to allow use of your version of
this file only
under the terms of the [____] License and not to
allow others to use
your version of this file under the MPL, indicate
your decision by
deleting the provisions above and replace them
with the notice and
other provisions required by the [___] License. If
you do not delete
the provisions above, a recipient may use your
version of this file
under either the MPL or the [___] License."
[NOTE: The text of this Exhibit A may differ slightly
from the text of the notices in the Source Code
files of the Original Code. You should use the text
of this Exhibit A rather than the text found in the
Original Code Source Code for Your Modifications.]
Apache License Version 2.0
Apache License
Version 2.0, January 2004
http://www.apache.org/licenses/
TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR USE, REPRODUCTION, AND DISTRIBUTION
1. Definitions.
"License" shall mean the terms and conditions for
use, reproduction, and distribution as defined by
Sections 1 through 9 of this document.
"Licensor" shall mean the copyright owner or entity
authorized by the copyright owner that is granting
the License.
"Legal Entity" shall mean the union of the acting
entity and all other entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common control with that
entity. For the purposes of this definition, "control"
means (i) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the
direction or management of such entity, whether
by contract or otherwise, or (ii) ownership of fifty
percent (50%) or more of the outstanding shares,
or (iii) beneficial ownership of such entity.
"You" (or "Your") shall mean an individual or Legal
Entity exercising permissions granted by this
License.
"Source" form shall mean the preferred form for
making modifications, including but not limited to
software source code, documentation source, and
configuration files.
"Object" form shall mean any form resulting from
mechanical transformation or translation of a
Source form, including but not limited to compiled
object code, generated documentation, and conversions to other media types.
"Work" shall mean the work of authorship, whether
in Source or Object form, made available under
the License, as indicated by a copyright notice that
is included in or attached to the work (an example
is provided in the Appendix below).
"Derivative Works" shall mean any work, whether
in Source or Object form, that is based on (or
derived from) the Work and for which the editorial
revisions, annotations, elaborations, or other modifications represent, as a whole, an original work of
authorship. For the purposes of this License, Derivative Works shall not include works that remain
separable from, or merely link (or bind by name) to
the interfaces of, the Work and Derivative Works
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
2. Grant of Copyright License. Subject to the terms
and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual, worldwide,
non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable
copyright license to reproduce, prepare Derivative
Works of, publicly display, publicly perform, sublicense, and distribute the Work and such Derivative
Works in Source or Object form.
3. Grant of Patent License. Subject to the terms
and conditions of this License, each Contributor hereby grants to You a perpetual, worldwide,
non-exclusive, no-charge, royalty-free, irrevocable
(except as stated in this section) patent license
to make, have made, use, offer to sell, sell,
import, and otherwise transfer the Work, where
such license applies only to those patent claims
licensable by such Contributor that are necessarily infringed by their Contribution(s) alone or
by combination of their Contribution(s) with the
Work to which such Contribution(s) was submitted. If You institute patent litigation against any
entity (including a cross-claim or counterclaim in
a lawsuit) alleging that the Work or a Contribution
incorporated within the Work constitutes direct or
contributory patent infringement, then any patent
licenses granted to You under this License for that
Work shall terminate as of the date such litigation
is filed.
4. Redistribution. You may reproduce and distribute copies of the Work or Derivative Works thereof
in any medium, with or without modifications, and
in Source or Object form, provided that You meet
the following conditions:
(a) You must give any other recipients of
the Work or Derivative Works a copy of this
License; and
(b) You must cause any modified files to carry
prominent notices stating that You changed the
files; and
(c) You must retain, in the Source form of any
Derivative Works that You distribute, all copyright, patent, trademark, and attribution notices
from the Source form of the Work, excluding
those notices that do not pertain to any part of
the Derivative Works; and
(d) If the Work includes a "NOTICE" text file
as part of its distribution, then any Derivative Works that You distribute must include
a readable copy of the attribution notices
contained within such NOTICE file, excluding those notices that do not pertain to any
part of the Derivative Works, in at least one
of the following places: within a NOTICE text
file distributed as part of the Derivative Works;
within the Source form or documentation, if
provided along with the Derivative Works; or,
within a display generated by the Derivative
Works, if and wherever such third-party notices
normally appear. The contents of the NOTICE
file are for informational purposes only and do
not modify the License. You may add Your own
attribution notices within Derivative Works that
You distribute, alongside or as an addendum to
the NOTICE text from the Work, provided that
such additional attribution notices cannot be
construed as modifying the License.
You may add Your own copyright statement to
Your modifications and may provide additional
or different license terms and conditions for use,
reproduction, or distribution of Your modifications,
or for any such Derivative Works as a whole,
provided Your use, reproduction, and distribution
of the Work otherwise complies with the conditions
stated in this License.
5. Submission of Contributions. Unless You explic-
ENGLISH
ENG
thereof.
"Contribution" shall mean any work of authorship,
including the original version of the Work and any
modifications or additions to that Work or Derivative Works thereof, that is intentionally submitted to
Licensor for inclusion in the Work by the copyright
owner or by an individual or Legal Entity authorized to submit on behalf of the copyright owner.
For the purposes of this definition, "submitted"
means any form of electronic, verbal, or written
communication sent to the Licensor or its representatives, including but not limited to communication on electronic mailing lists, source code
control systems, and issue tracking systems that
are managed by, or on behalf of, the Licensor for
the purpose of discussing and improving the Work,
but excluding communication that is conspicuously
marked or otherwise designated in writing by the
copyright owner as "Not a Contribution."
"Contributor" shall mean Licensor and any individual or Legal Entity on behalf of whom a Contribution has been received by Licensor and subsequently incorporated within the Work.
177
178
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
itly state otherwise, any Contribution intentionally
submitted for inclusion in the Work by You to the
Licensor shall be under the terms and conditions
of this License, without any additional terms or
conditions. Notwithstanding the above, nothing
herein shall supersede or modify the terms of any
separate license agreement you may have executed with Licensor regarding such Contributions.
6. Trademarks. This License does not grant
permission to use the trade names, trademarks,
service marks, or product names of the Licensor,
except as required for reasonable and customary
use in describing the origin of the Work and reproducing the content of the NOTICE file.
ENGLISH
ENG
7. Disclaimer of Warranty. Unless required by
applicable law or agreed to in writing, Licensor
provides the Work (and each Contributor provides
its Contributions) on an "AS IS" BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF ANY
KIND, either express or implied, including, without
limitation, any warranties or conditions of TITLE,
NON-INFRINGEMENT, MERCHANTABILITY, or
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. You
are solely responsible for determining the appropriateness of using or redistributing the Work and
assume any risks associated with Your exercise of
permissions under this License.
8. Limitation of Liability. In no event and under no
legal theory, whether in tort (including negligence),
contract, or otherwise, unless required by applicable law (such as deliberate and grossly negligent
acts) or agreed to in writing, shall any Contributor
be liable to You for damages, including any direct,
indirect, special, incidental, or consequential damages of any character arising as a result of this
License or out of the use or inability to use the
Work (including but not limited to damages for loss
of goodwill, work stoppage, computer failure or
malfunction, or any and all other commercial damages or losses), even if such Contributor has been
advised of the possibility of such damages.
9. Accepting Warranty or Additional Liability.
While redistributing the Work or Derivative Works
thereof, You may choose to offer, and charge a fee
for, acceptance of support, warranty, indemnity,
or other liability obligations and/or rights consistent with this License. However, in accepting such
obligations, You may act only on Your own behalf
and on Your sole responsibility, not on behalf of
any other Contributor, and only if You agree to
indemnify, defend, and hold each Contributor
harmless for any liability incurred by, or claims asserted against, such Contributor by reason of your
accepting any such warranty or additional liability.
END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
MIT license
- cares
Copyright 1998 by the Massachusetts Institute of
Technology.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this
software and its documentation for any purpose
and without fee is hereby granted, provided that
the above copyright notice appear in all copies and
that both that copyright notice and this permission
notice appear in supporting documentation, and
that the name of M.I.T. not be used in advertising
or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software
without specific, written prior permission. M.I.T.
makes no representations about the suitability of
this software for any purpose.
It is provided "as is" without express or implied
warranty.
KEITH PACKARD DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES
WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT
SHALL KEITH PACKARD BE LIABLE FOR ANY
SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER
RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR
PROFITS, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS
ACTION, ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION
WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
SOFTWARE.
- libcurl
Copyright (c) 1996 - 2010, Daniel Stenberg, <[email protected]>.
All rights reserved.
Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute
this software for any purpose with or without fee is
hereby granted, provided that the above copyright
notice and this permission notice appear in all
copies.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS
OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED
TO THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY
RIGHTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHORS
OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS BE LIABLE FOR
ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT
OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE
OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE
SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
- libxml2
Copyright (C) 1998-2003 Daniel Veillard. All
Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
ENGLISH
ENG
- fontconfig
Copyright (c) 2000 Keith Packard
Copyright (c) 2005 Patrick Lam
Permission to use, copy, modify, distribute, and
sell this software and its documentation for any
purpose is hereby granted without fee, provided
that the above copyright notice appear in all copies
and that both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in supporting documentation,
and that the name of Keith Packard not be used
in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the software without specific, written prior
permission. Keith Packard makes no representations about the suitability of this software for any
purpose.
It is provided "as is" without express or implied
warranty.
179
180
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
DANIEL VEILLARD BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM,
DAMAGES OR OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN
AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE SOFTWARE OR THE USE
OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of
Daniel Veillard shall not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from him
- libxslt
Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Daniel Veillard.
Copyright (C) 2001-2002 Thomas Broyer, Charlie
Bozeman and Daniel Veillard.
ENGLISH
ENG
All Rights Reserved.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of
Daniel Veillard shall not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization from him.
- lua interpreter
Copyright © 1994–2010 Lua.org, PUC-Rio.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
181
Expat license
The FreeType Project LICENSE
The source package was downloaded from
<URL:http://expat.sourceforge.net>.
Copyright 1996-2002, 2006 by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg
The original packager is Adam Di Carlo <aph@
debian.org>.
The current maintainer is Ardo van Rangelrooij
<[email protected]>.
Introduction
Copyright (c) 1998, 1999, 2000 Thai Open Source
Software Center Ltd and Clark Cooper
Copyright (c) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
Expat maintainers.
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
This license applies to all files found in such packages, and which do not fall under their own explicit
license. The license affects thus the FreeType font
engine, the test programs, documentation and
makefiles, at the very least.
This license was inspired by the BSD, Artistic, and
IJG (Independent JPEG Group) licenses, which
all encourage inclusion and use of free software
in commercial and freeware products alike. As a
consequence, its main points are that:
- We don't promise that this software works.
However, we will be interested in any kind of
bug reports. (`as is' distribution)
- You can use this software for whatever you
want, in parts or full form, without having to pay
us. (`royalty-free' usage)
- You may not pretend that you wrote this
software. If you use it, or only parts of it, in a
program, you must acknowledge somewhere
in your documentation that you have used the
FreeType code. (`credits')
We specifically permit and encourage the inclusion
of this software, with or without modifications, in
commercial products. We disclaim all warranties
covering The FreeType Project and assume no
liability related to The FreeType Project.
Finally, many people asked us for a preferred form
for a credit/disclaimer to use in compliance with
this license. We thus encourage you to use the
following text:
Portions of this software are copyright <year>
The FreeType Project (www.freetype.org). All
rights reserved.
Please replace <year> with the value from the
FreeType version you actually use.
ENGLISH
ENG
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The FreeType Project is distributed in several
archive packages; some of them may contain, in
addition to the FreeType font engine, various tools
and contributions which rely on, or relate to, the
FreeType Project.
182
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
Legal Terms
0. Definitions
Throughout this license, the terms `package',
`FreeType Project' and `FreeType archive' refer to
the set of files originally distributed by the authors
(David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner Lemberg) as the `FreeType Project', be they named as
alpha, beta or final release.
ENGLISH
ENG
`You' refers to the licensee, or person using the
project, where `using' is a generic term including
compiling the project's source code as well as
linking it to form a `program' or `executable'. This
program is referred to as `a program using the
FreeType engine'.
This license applies to all files distributed in the
original FreeType Project, including all source
code, binaries and documentation, unless otherwise stated in the file in its original, unmodified
form as distributed in the original archive. If you
are unsure whether or not a particular file is covered by this license, you must contact us to verify
this.
The FreeType Project is copyright (C) 1996-2000
by David Turner, Robert Wilhelm, and Werner
Lemberg. All rights reserved except as specified
below.
1. No Warranty
THE FREETYPE PROJECT IS PROVIDED
`AS IS' WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND,
EITHER EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. IN NO EVENT WILL ANY OF
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES CAUSED BY
THE USE OR THE INABILITY TO USE, OF THE
FREETYPE PROJECT.
2. Redistribution
This license grants a worldwide, royalty-free,
perpetual and irrevocable right and license to use,
execute, perform, compile, display, copy, create derivative works of, distribute and sublicense
the FreeType Project (in both source and object
code forms) and derivative works thereof for any
purpose; and to authorize others to exercise some
or all of the rights granted herein, subject to the
following conditions:
- Redistribution of source code must retain this
license file (`FTL.TXT') unaltered; any addi-
tions, deletions or changes to the original files
must be clearly indicated in accompanying
documentation. The copyright notices of the
unaltered, original files must be preserved in all
copies of source files.
- Redistribution in binary form must provide
a disclaimer that states that the software is
based in part of the work of the FreeType
Team, in the distribution documentation. We
also encourage you to put an URL to the
FreeType web page in your documentation,
though this isn't mandatory.
These conditions apply to any software derived
from or based on the FreeType Project, not just
the unmodified files. If you use our work, you must
acknowledge us. However, no fee need be paid to
us.
3. Advertising
Neither the FreeType authors and contributors nor
you shall use the name of the other for commercial, advertising, or promotional purposes without
specific prior written permission. We suggest, but
do not require, that you use one or more of the
following phrases to refer to this software in your
documentation or advertising materials: `FreeType
Project', `FreeType Engine', `FreeType library', or
`FreeType Distribution'.
As you have not signed this license, you are not
required to accept it. However, as the FreeType
Project is copyrighted material, only this license,
or another one contracted with the authors, grants
you the right to use, distribute, and modify it.
Therefore, by using, distributing, or modifying the
FreeType Project, you indicate that you understand and accept all the terms of this license.
4. Contacts
There are two mailing lists related to FreeType:
[email protected]
Discusses general use and applications of
FreeType, as well as future and wanted additions
to the library and distribution. If you are looking
for support, start in this list if you haven't found
anything to help you in the documentation.
[email protected]
Discusses bugs, as well as engine internals, design issues, specific licenses, porting, etc.
Our home page can be found at http://www.
freetype.org
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
183
JPEG license
OpenSSL License
This software is copyright (C) 1991-1998, Thomas
G. Lane.
All Rights Reserved except as specified below.
Copyright (c) 1998-2008 The OpenSSL Project. All
rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright notice, this list of conditions
and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or
use of this software must display the following acknowledgment:
"This product includes software
developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the
OpenSSL Toolkit. (http://www.openssl.org/)"
4. The names "OpenSSL Toolkit" and "OpenSSL
Project" must not be used to endorse or promote
products derived from this software without prior
written permission. For written permission, please
contact [email protected].
5. Products derived from this software may not be
called "OpenSSL" nor may "OpenSSL" appear in
their names without prior written permission of the
OpenSSL Project.
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must
retain the following acknowledgment:
"This product includes software developed by the
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit
(http://www.openssl.org/)"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESSED
OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT
OR ITS CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY
DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL,
EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER
IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT
ENGLISH
ENG
Permission is hereby granted to use, copy, modify,
and distribute this software (or portions thereof) for
any purpose, without fee, subject to these conditions:
(1) If any part of the source code for this
software is distributed, then this README file
must be included, with this copyright and nowarranty notice unaltered; and any additions,
deletions, or changes to the original files must
be clearly indicated in accompanying documentation.
(2) If only executable code is distributed, then
the accompanying documentation must state
that "this software is based in part on the work
of the Independent JPEG Group".
(3) Permission for use of this software is
granted only if the user accepts full responsibility for any undesirable consequences; the
authors accept NO LIABILITY for damages of
any kind.
184
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
(INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF
THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young ([email protected]).
This product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Original SSLeay License
Copyright (C) 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]) All rights reserved.
This package is an SSL implementation written by
Eric Young ([email protected]).
The implementation was written so as to conform
with Netscapes SSL.
ENGLISH
ENG
This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use as long as the following conditions are
aheared to. The following conditions apply to all
code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA,
lhash, DES, etc., code; not just the SSL code. The
SSL documentation included with this distribution
is covered by the same copyright terms except
that the holder is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).
Copyright remains Eric Young's, and as such
any Copyright notices in the code are not to be
removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric
Young should be given attribution as the author
of the parts of the library used. This can be in the
form of a textual message at program startup or in
documentation (online or textual) provided with the
package.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright notice, this list of conditions
and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features
or use of this software must display the following
acknowledgement:
"This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young ([email protected])"
The word 'cryptographic' can be left out if the
rouines from the library being used are not cryptographic related :-).
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or a
derivative thereof) from the apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:
"This product includes software written by Tim
Hudson ([email protected])"
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC
YOUNG ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO
EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS
OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS
INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON
ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING
IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY
OF SUCH DAMAGE.
The licence and distribution terms for any publically available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed. i.e. this code cannot simply be
copied and put under another distribution licence
[including the GNU Public Licence.]
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
185
zlib/libpng License
Portmap license
This product may contain open source software
licensed under zlib/libpng License.
Most of the files, fall under the following copyright,
and are distributable under the terms of the BSD
license.
Libmng : Copyright © 2000-2008 Gerard Juyn
([email protected])
Libpng : Copyright (c) 1998-2008 Glenn RandersPehrson
(Version 0.96 Copyright (c) 1996, 1997 Andreas
Dilger)
(Version 0.88 Copyright (c) 1995, 1996 Guy Eric
Schalnat, Group 42, Inc.)
Zlib : Copyright (C) 1995-2010 Jean-loup Gailly
and Mark Adler
1. The origin of this software must not be misrepresented; you must not claim that you wrote
the original software. If you use this software in
a product, an acknowledgment in the product
documentation would be appreciated but is not
required.
2. Altered source versions must be plainly marked
as such, and must not be misrepresented as being
the original software.
3. This notice may not be removed or altered from
any source distribution.
Jean-loup Gailly
Mark Adler
Some of the RPC code, is copyrighted by Sun
Microsystems, and is provided under the following
terms:
Sun RPC is a product of Sun Microsystems, Inc.
and is provided for unrestricted use provided that
this legend is included on all tape media and as a
part of the software program in whole or part. Users may copy or modify Sun RPC without charge,
but are not authorized to license or distribute it
to anyone else except as part of a product or
program developed by the user or with the express
written consent of Sun Microsystems, Inc.
SUN RPC IS PROVIDED AS IS WITH NO WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND INCLUDING THE WARRANTIES OF DESIGN, MERCHANTIBILITY AND
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, OR
ARISING FROM A COURSE OF DEALING, USAGE OR TRADE PRACTICE.
Sun RPC is provided with no support and without
any obligation on the part of Sun Microsystems,
Inc. to assist in its use, correction, modification or
enhancement.
SUN MICROSYSTEMS, INC. SHALL HAVE NO
LIABILITY WITH RESPECT TO THE INFRINGEMENT OF COPYRIGHTS, TRADE SECRETS
OR ANY PATENTS BY SUN RPC OR ANY PART
THEREOF.
In no event will Sun Microsystems, Inc. be liable
for any lost revenue or profits or other special, indirect and consequential damages, even if Sun has
been advised of the possibility of such damages.
Sun Microsystems, Inc.
2550 Garcia Avenue
ENGLISH
ENG
This software is provided 'as-is', without any
express or implied warranty. In no event will the
authors be held liable for any damages arising
from the use of this software.
Permission is granted to anyone to use this
software for any purpose, including commercial
applications, and to alter it and redistribute it freely,
subject to the following restrictions:
Copyright (c) 1983,1991 The Regents of the University of California. ll rights reserved.
186
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
Pixman license
X.net license
Copyright 1987, 1988, 1989, 1998 The Open
Group
Copyright 1987, 1988, 1989 Digital Equipment
Corporation
Copyright 1999, 2004, 2008 Keith Packard
Copyright 2000 SuSE, Inc.
Copyright 2000 Keith Packard, member of The
XFree86 Project, Inc.
Copyright 2004, 2005, 2007, 2008 Red Hat, Inc.
Copyright 2004 Nicholas Miell
Copyright 2005 Lars Knoll & Zack Rusin, Trolltech
Copyright 2005 Trolltech AS
Copyright 2007 Luca Barbato
Copyright 2008 Aaron Plattner, NVIDIA Corporation
Copyright 2008 Rodrigo Kumpera
Copyright 2008 André Tupinambá
Copyright 2008 Mozilla Corporation
Copyright 2008 Frederic Plourde
Copyright 2009 Sun Microsystems, Inc.
Copyright (c) 1995-2001 International Business
Machines Corporation and others
All rights reserved.
ENGLISH
ENG
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice (including the next paragraph) shall be
included in all copies or substantial portions of the
Software.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, and/or sell copies of the
Software, and to permit persons to whom the Software is furnished to do so, provided that the above
copyright notice(s) and this permission notice
appear in all copies of the Software and that both
the above copyright notice(s) and this permission
notice appear in supporting documentation.
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS.
IN NO EVENT SHALL THE COPYRIGHT HOLDER OR HOLDERS INCLUDED IN THIS NOTICE
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, OR ANY SPECIAL
INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES,
OR ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT,
NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH
THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
Except as contained in this notice, the name of a
copyright holder shall not be used in advertising or
otherwise to promote the sale, use or other dealings in this Software without prior written authorization of the copyright holder.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
BSD license
- netBSD
Copyright (c) 1998 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc.
All rights reserved.
This code is derived from software contributed to
The NetBSD Foundation by Lennart Augustsson
([email protected]) at Carlstedt Research &
Technology.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC. AND CONTRIBUTORS
``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT
SHALL THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT
LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
OWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE
OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT
OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
- Simple XML Parser
Copyright (c) 2001-2002 Bruno Essmann <[email protected]>
All rights reserved.
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the
above copyright notice, this list of conditions and
the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce
the above copyright notice, this list of conditions
and the following disclaimer in the documentation
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
3. The name of the author may not be used to
endorse or promote products derived from this
software without specific prior written permission.
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE
AUTHOR ``AS IS'' AND ANY EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT
NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN
NO EVENT SHALL THE AUTHOR BE LIABLE
FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL,
SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR
SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY,
WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,
OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE
USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
- xyssl
Copyright (C) 2006-2008 Christophe Devine
Copyright (C) 2009 Paul Bakker <polarssl_maintainer at polarssl dot org>
All rights reserved.
ENGLISH
ENG
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
3. All advertising materials mentioning features
or use of this software must display the following acknowledgement:
This product includes software developed by
the NetBSD Foundation, Inc. and its contributors.
4. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its contributors may be
used to endorse or promote products derived
from this software without specific prior written
permission.
187
188
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
ENGLISH
ENG
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms,
with or without modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:
1. Redistributions of source code must retain
the above copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice, this list of
conditions and the following disclaimer in the
documentation and/or other materials provided
with the distribution.
3. Neither the names of PolarSSL or XySSL
nor the names of its contributors may be used
to endorse or promote products derived from
this software without specific prior written
permission.
RSA Data Security license
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS "AS
IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
COPYRIGHT OWNER OR CONTRIBUTORS BE
LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE
GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA,
OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF
LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN
IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
DAMAGE.
RSA Data Security, Inc. makes no representations concerning either the merchantability of this
software or the suitability of this software for any
particular purpose. It is provided "as is" without
express or implied warranty of any kind.
These notices must be retained in any copies of
any part of this documentation and/or software.
Copyright (C) 1991-2, RSA Data Security, Inc. Created 1991. All rights reserved.
License to copy and use this software is granted
provided that it is identified as the "RSA Data
Security, Inc. MD5 Message-Digest Algorithm" in
all material mentioning or referencing this software
or this function.
License is also granted to make and use derivative works provided that such works are identified
as "derived from the RSA Data Security, Inc. MD5
Message-Digest Algorithm" in all material mentioning or referencing the derived work.
OPEN SOURCE LICENSE
189
JSON license
MS92 license
Copyright (c) 2005 JSON.org
Copyright (C) 1992 Michael Sample and the University of British Columbia
Permission is hereby granted, free of charge, to
any person obtaining a copy of this software and
associated documentation files (the "Software"), to
deal in the Software without restriction, including
without limitation the rights to use, copy, modify,
merge, publish, distribute, sublicense, and/or sell
copies of the Software, and to permit persons to
whom the Software is furnished to do so, subject
to the following conditions:
The above copyright notice and this permission
notice shall be included in all copies or substantial
portions of the Software.
This library is free software; you can redistribute it
and/or modify it provided that this copyright/license
information is retained in original form.
If you modify this file, you must clearly indicate
your changes.
This source code is distributed in the hope that it
will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY;
without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR
PURPOSE.
The Software shall be used for Good, not Evil.
ENGLISH
ENG
THE SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED "AS IS", WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR
IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
THE WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY,
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE AND
NONINFRINGEMENT. IN NO EVENT SHALL
THE AUTHORS OR COPYRIGHT HOLDERS
BE LIABLE FOR ANY CLAIM, DAMAGES OR
OTHER LIABILITY, WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF
CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE, ARISING
FROM, OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE
SOFTWARE OR THE USE OR OTHER DEALINGS IN THE SOFTWARE.
(Only DTV)
The model and serial numbers of the TV is
located on the back of the TV
Record it below should you ever need service.
MODEL
SERIAL
Trade Mark of the DVB Digital Video
Broadcasting Project (1991 to 1996)

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

Download PDF

advertisement